blob: f4a435464a23a2f2cfe22707689496ea53c94b7b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau71f95fa2020-01-22 10:34:58 +01007 2020/01/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - presetenv
615 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - uid
617 - ulimit-n
618 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200619 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100620 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200621 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-options
625 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-options
628 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200672 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200673 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200674 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100675 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200676 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200677 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100678 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100680 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.session-timeout
682 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200683 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100684 - tune.maxaccept
685 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200686 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200687 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200688 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100689 - tune.rcvbuf.client
690 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100691 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200692 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.sndbuf.client
694 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100695 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200697 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100698 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200699 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200700 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100701 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100703 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200704 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
705 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
706 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100707 - tune.zlib.memlevel
708 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 * Debugging
711 - debug
712 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713
714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716------------------------------------
717
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200718ca-base <dir>
719 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200720 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
721 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723chroot <jail dir>
724 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
725 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
726 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
727 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
728 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100730
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
732 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
733 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
734 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
735 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
736 set. These sets have the format
737
738 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
739
740 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
743 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100744 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
745 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100747 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
751 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
752 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
753 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100754
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100755 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
756 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
757 on the machine's word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
761 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
762 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
763 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
764 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
765 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766
767 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
769
770 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
771 # first 4 CPUs
772
773 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
774 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
775 # word size.
776
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
784 # and so on.
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100789 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
791 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
792 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
793
794 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
795 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
797
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100798 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
799 # and a thread range.
800 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
803
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200804crt-base <dir>
805 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100806 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
807 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809daemon
810 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
811 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100812 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
813 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815deviceatlas-json-file <path>
816 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100817 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200818
819deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100820 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
822
823deviceatlas-separator <char>
824 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
825 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
826
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100827deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200828 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
829 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
830 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100831
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900832external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100833 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
834 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100835 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
836 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
837 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
838 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
839 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841gid <number>
842 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
843 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
844 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100845 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
846 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100848
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100849group <group name>
850 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
851 See also "gid" and "user".
852
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100853hard-stop-after <time>
854 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
855
856 Arguments :
857 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
858 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
859 SIGUSR1 signal.
860
861 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
862 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
863 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
864
865 Example:
866 global
867 hard-stop-after 30s
868
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200869h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
870 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
871 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
872 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
873 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
874 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
875 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
876 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
877 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
878 specified in a proxy.
879
880 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
881 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
882 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
883 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
884 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
885 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
886 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
887
888 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
889 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
890 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
891 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
892 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
893
894 Example:
895 global
896 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
897
898 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
899 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
900
901h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
902 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
903 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
904 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
905 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
906 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
907 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
908 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
909 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
910
911 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
912 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
913 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
914
915 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
916 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
917
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100918insecure-fork-wanted
919 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
920 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
921 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
922 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
923 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
924 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
925 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
926 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
927 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
928 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
929 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
930 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
931 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
932 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
933 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
934 disable it.
935
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100936insecure-setuid-wanted
937 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
938 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
939 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
940 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
941 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
942 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
943 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
944 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
945 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
946 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
947 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
948 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
949 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
950 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
951
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
953 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100954 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100955 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100956 configured with "log global".
957
958 <address> can be one of:
959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100960 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100961 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
962 port).
963
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100964 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
965 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
966 port).
967
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100968 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100969 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
970 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100972
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100973 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
974 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
975 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
976 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
977 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
978 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
979 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
980 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
981 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
982 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
983 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
984 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
985 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
986 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100987 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
988 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100989
990 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
991 "fd@2", see above.
992
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200993 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
994 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
995 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
996 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
997 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
998
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1000 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001001
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001002 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1003 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1004 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1005 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1006 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1007 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1008 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1009 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1010 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1011 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001012 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1013 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001014
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001015 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1016 one of the following :
1017
1018 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1019 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1020
1021 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1022 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1023
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001024 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1025 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1026 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1027 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1028 logger consumes.
1029
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001030 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1031 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1032 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1033 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1034
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001035 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1036 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1037 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1038 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1039 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1040
1041 <sample_size>
1042 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1043 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1044 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1045 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1046 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1047
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001048 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001050 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1051 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1052 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1053
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001054 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1055 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1056 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1057 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058
1059 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001060 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1061 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1062 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1063 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1064 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1065 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001067 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001069log-send-hostname [<string>]
1070 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1071 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1072 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1073 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1074 the logs.
1075
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001076log-tag <string>
1077 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1078 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1079 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001080 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082lua-load <file>
1083 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1084 used multiple times.
1085
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001086lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1087 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1088 variable.
1089 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1090 to "path".
1091
1092 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1093 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1094 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1095 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1096 will be checked earlier.
1097
1098 As an example by specifying the following path:
1099
1100 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1101 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1102
1103 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1104 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1105 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1106 paths if that does not exist either.
1107
1108 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1109 documentation.
1110
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001111master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001112 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1113 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1114 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001115 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001116 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1117 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001118 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1119 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1120 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1121 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1122 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001123
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001124 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001125
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001126mworker-max-reloads <number>
1127 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001128 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001129 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1130 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1131 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133nbproc <number>
1134 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1135 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1136 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001137 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1138 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001139 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1140 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001142nbthread <number>
1143 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001144 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1145 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1146 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1147 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1148 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001149 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1150 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1151 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1152 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1153 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1154 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1155 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001156
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1160 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162presetenv <name> <value>
1163 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1164 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1165 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1166 and "unsetenv".
1167
1168resetenv [<name> ...]
1169 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1170 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1171 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1172 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1173 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1174 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1175 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1176 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1177
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001178stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001179 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1180 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1181 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1182 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1183 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1184 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001185 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001186 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1187 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1188 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1189 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001190
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001191server-state-base <directory>
1192 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001193 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1194 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001195
1196server-state-file <file>
1197 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1198 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1199 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1200 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1201 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1202 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1203 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1204 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001205 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1206 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001207
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001208setenv <name> <value>
1209 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1210 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1211 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1212 and "unsetenv".
1213
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001214set-dumpable
1215 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001216 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1217 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1218 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1219 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1220 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1221 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1222 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1223 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1224 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1225 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1226 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1227 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1228 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1229 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1230 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1231 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1232 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001234ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1236 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001237 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001238 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001239 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1240 information and recommendations see e.g.
1241 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1242 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1243 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1244 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001245
1246ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1248 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1249 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1250 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1251 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001252 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1253 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1254 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001255 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001256
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001257ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1259 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1260 keyword to see available options.
1261
1262 Example:
1263 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001264 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001265
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001266ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1268 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001269 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001270 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1272 information and recommendations see e.g.
1273 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1274 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1275 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1276 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1277 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1282 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1283 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1284 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1288 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1293 keyword to see available options.
1294
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1298 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001299 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001300 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001301 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1302 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1303 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1304 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001305 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1306 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1307 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1308
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001309ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer>*
1310 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1311 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1312
1313 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1314 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1315 optimize the startup time.
1316
1317 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1318 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1319 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1320
1321 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
1322 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer.
1323
1324 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1325 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1326 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1327 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1328 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1329 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
1330 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specifiy both the ECDSA
1331 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1332
1333 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1334
1335 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1336
1337 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1338 not provided in the PEM file.
1339
1340 The default behavior is "all".
1341
1342 Example:
1343 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1344 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1345 ssl-load-extra-files none
1346
1347 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1348
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001349ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1350 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1351 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1352 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1353
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001354stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1355 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1356 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1357 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001358 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001359 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001360
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001361 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1362 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1363 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001364
1365stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1366 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1367 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001368 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001369
1370stats maxconn <connections>
1371 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1372 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1373
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001374uid <number>
1375 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1376 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1377 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1378 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1379
1380ulimit-n <number>
1381 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1382 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1383 option.
1384
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001385unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1386 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1387
1388 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1389 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1390 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1391 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1392 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1393 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1394 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1395 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1396 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1397 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1398
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001399unsetenv [<name> ...]
1400 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1401 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1402 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1403 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1404 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1405 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1406 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1407
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001408user <user name>
1409 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1410 See also "uid" and "group".
1411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001412node <name>
1413 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1414
1415 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1416 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1417 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1418 traffic.
1419
1420description <text>
1421 Add a text that describes the instance.
1422
1423 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1424 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1425 "<" and ">" characters.
1426
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100142751degrees-data-file <file path>
1428 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001429 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001430
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001431 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001432 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1433
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000143451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001435 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1436 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1437 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1438
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001439 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001440 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1441
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200144251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001443 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1444 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1445
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1447 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1448
144951degrees-cache-size <number>
1450 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1451 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1452 By default, this cache is disabled.
1453
1454 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001455 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1456
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001457wurfl-data-file <file path>
1458 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1459 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1460
1461 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1462 with USE_WURFL=1.
1463
1464wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1465 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1466 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1467 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1468
1469 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1470
1471 Valid WURFL properties are:
1472 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1473
1474 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1475 device.
1476
1477 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1478 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1479
1480 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1481 particular web request.
1482
1483 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1484 used Libwurfl API version.
1485
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001486 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1487 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1488
1489 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1490 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1491
1492 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1493
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1495 with USE_WURFL=1.
1496
1497wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1498 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1499 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1500
1501 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1502 with USE_WURFL=1.
1503
1504wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1505 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1506 thus before the chroot.
1507
1508 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1509 with USE_WURFL=1.
1510
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001511wurfl-cache-size <size>
1512 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1513 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001514 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001515 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1518 with USE_WURFL=1.
1519
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001520strict-limits
1521 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1522 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1523 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1524 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1525 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1526 keyword.
1527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015283.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529-----------------------
1530
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001531busy-polling
1532 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1533 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1534 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1535 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1536 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1537 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1538 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1539 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1540 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1541 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1542 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1543 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1544 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1545 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1546 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1547 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1548 "poll" pollers.
1549
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001550 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1551 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1552 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1553
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001554max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1555 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1556 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1557 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1558 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1559 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1560 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1561 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1562 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001564maxconn <number>
1565 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1566 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1567 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001568 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1569 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1570 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1571 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001572 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1573 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1574 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1575 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1576 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1577 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001579maxconnrate <number>
1580 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1581 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1582 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1583 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1584 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1585 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1586 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1587 fairness.
1588
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001589maxcomprate <number>
1590 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001591 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001592 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1593 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1594 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001596 default value.
1597
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001598maxcompcpuusage <number>
1599 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1600 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1601 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1602 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1603 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1604 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1605 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1606 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1607
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001608maxpipes <number>
1609 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1610 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1611 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1612 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1613 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1614 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1615
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001616maxsessrate <number>
1617 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1618 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1619 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1620 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1621 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1622 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1623 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1624 fairness.
1625
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001626maxsslconn <number>
1627 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1628 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1629 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1630 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1631 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1632 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1633 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001634 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1635 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1636 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1637 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1638 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1639 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1640 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001641
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001642maxsslrate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1644 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1645 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1646 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1647 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1648 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1649 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1650 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1651 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1652 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1653
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001654maxzlibmem <number>
1655 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1656 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1657 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001658 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1659 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1660 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662noepoll
1663 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1664 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001665 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001666
1667nokqueue
1668 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1669 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1670 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1671
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001672noevports
1673 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1674 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1675 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1676 also "nopoll".
1677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001678nopoll
1679 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1680 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001682 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1683 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001684
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001685nosplice
1686 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001688 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001689 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001690 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1691 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1692 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1693 "option splice-response".
1694
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001695nogetaddrinfo
1696 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1697 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1698
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001699noreuseport
1700 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1701 command line argument "-dR".
1702
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001703profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1704 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1705 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1706 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1707 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001708 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001709 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1710 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1711 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1712 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1713
1714 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1715 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1716 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1717 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1718 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001719 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1720 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1721 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1722 CLI.
1723
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001724spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001725 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1726 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1727 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1728 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1729 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1730 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001731
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001732ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001733 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001735 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1736 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1737 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1738 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1739 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1741 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001742 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1743 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1744 openssl configuration file uses:
1745 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1746
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001747ssl-mode-async
1748 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001749 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001750 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1751 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1752 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001753 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001754 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001755
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001756tune.buffers.limit <number>
1757 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1758 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1759 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1760 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1761 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001763 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1764 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1765 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1766 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1767 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1768 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1769 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1770 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1771 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1772
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001773tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1774 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1775 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1776 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1777 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1778
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001779tune.bufsize <number>
1780 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1781 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1782 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1783 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1784 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1785 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1786 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001787 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1788 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1789 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001790 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001791 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1792 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1793 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001794
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001795tune.chksize <number>
1796 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1797 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1798 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1799 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1800 checks whenever possible.
1801
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001802tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1803 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1804 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1805 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1806 this value. The default value is 1.
1807
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001808tune.fail-alloc
1809 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1810 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1811 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1812 gracefully.
1813
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001814tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1815 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1816 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1817 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1818 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1819 change it.
1820
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001821tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1822 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1824 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001825 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1826 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1827 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1828 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1829 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1830
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001831tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1832 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1833 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1834 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1835 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1836 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1837 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1838 recommended not to change this value.
1839
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001840tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1841 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1842 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1843 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1844 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1845 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1846 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1847 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1848
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001849tune.http.cookielen <number>
1850 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1851 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1852 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1853 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1854 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1855 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1856 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1857 to change this value.
1858
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001859tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1861 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001862 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001864 configuration directives too.
1865 The default value is 1024.
1866
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001867tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1868 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1869 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1870 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1871 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1872 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1873 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001874 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1875 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1876 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001877
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001878tune.idletimer <timeout>
1879 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1880 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1881 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1882 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1883 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1884 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001885 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001886 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001887 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1888
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001889tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1890 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1891 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1892 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1893 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1894 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1895 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1896 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1897 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1898 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1899
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001900tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1901 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001902 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001903 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1904 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001905 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001906 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1907 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1908
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001909tune.lua.maxmem
1910 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1911 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1912 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1913 memory.
1914
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001915tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1916 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001917 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1918 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001920
1921tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1922 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1923 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1924 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1925 check servers.
1926
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001927tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1928 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1929 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1930 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001932
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001933tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001934 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1935 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1936 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1937 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1938 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1939 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1940 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1941 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1942 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1943 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001944
1945tune.maxpollevents <number>
1946 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1947 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1948 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1949 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1950 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1951
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001952tune.maxrewrite <number>
1953 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1954 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1955 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1956 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1957 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1958 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1959 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1960 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1961 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1962 bufsize.
1963
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001964tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1965 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1966 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1967 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1968 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1969 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1970 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1971 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1972 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1973 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001974 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1975 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001976 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1977 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1978 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1979 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1980 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1981 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1982 setting this parameter to 0.
1983
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001984tune.pipesize <number>
1985 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1986 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1987 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1988 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1989 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1990 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1991
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001992tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1993 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1994 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1995 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1996 default is 20.
1997
1998tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1999 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2000 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2001 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2002 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2003 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2004 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002005 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002006
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002007tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2008tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2009 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2010 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2011 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002012 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002013 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002014 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2015 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2016
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002017tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002019 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2020 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2021 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2022 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2023
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002024tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002025 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002026 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2027 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2028
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002029tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2030tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2031 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2032 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2033 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002034 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002035 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002036 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2037 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2038 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2039 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2040 notifying haproxy again.
2041
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002042tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002043 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2044 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2045 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002046 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002047 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002048 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002049 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2050 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2051 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002052 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2053 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002054
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002055tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002056 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002057 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2058 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2059 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2060 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2061 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2062
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002063tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2064 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002066 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2067 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2068 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2069 being used for too long.
2070
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002071tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2072 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2073 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2074 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2075 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2076 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2077 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2078 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2079 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2080 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2081 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002082 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002083 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002084
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002085tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2086 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2087 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2088 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2089 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2090 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2091 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2092 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002093 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2094 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002095
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002096tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2097 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2098 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2099 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2100 1000 entries.
2101
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002102tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2103 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2104 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2105 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002107tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002108tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002109tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2110tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2111tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002112 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2113 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2114 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2115 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2116 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2117 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2118 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2119 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002120
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002121 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2122 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2123 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2124 all available space is consumed.
2125 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2126 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2127 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002128
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002129tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2130 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002131 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002132 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002133 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002134 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2135
2136tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2137 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2138 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2140 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021423.3. Debugging
2143--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
2145debug
2146 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2147 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2148 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2149 system startup.
2150
2151quiet
2152 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2153 line argument "-q".
2154
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021563.4. Userlists
2157--------------
2158It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2159http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2160it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2161
2162userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002163 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002164 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2165
2166group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002167 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002168 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2169 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2170
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002171user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2172 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002173 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2174 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002175 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2176 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2177 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2178 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002179
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002180 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2181 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2182 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2183 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2184 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2185 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2186 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2187 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2188 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002189
2190 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002191 userlist L1
2192 group G1 users tiger,scott
2193 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002194
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002195 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2196 user scott insecure-password elgato
2197 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199 userlist L2
2200 group G1
2201 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002202
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002203 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2204 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2205 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002206
2207 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002208
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002209
22103.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002211----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002212It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2213several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2214instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2215values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2216automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2217In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2218using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2219tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2220reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2221Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2222that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2223each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224
2225peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002226 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002227 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2228
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002229bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2230 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2231 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2232
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002233disabled
2234 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2235 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2236 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2237
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002238default-bind [param*]
2239 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2240
2241default-server [param*]
2242 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2243
2244 Arguments:
2245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2246 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2247 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2248 details.
2249
2250
2251 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2252
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002253enable
2254 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2255
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002256log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2257 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2258 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2259 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2260 more details.
2261
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002262peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002263 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2264 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2265 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2266 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2267 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2268 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2269
2270 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2271 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2272
2273 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2274 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2275 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2276 across all peers.
2277
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002278 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2279 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002280
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002281 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2282 "server" keyword explanation below).
2283
2284server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002285 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002286 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2287 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2288 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2289 of this "peers" section).
2290 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2291
2292
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002293 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002294 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002295 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002296 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2297 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2298 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002299
2300 backend mybackend
2301 mode tcp
2302 balance roundrobin
2303 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2304 stick on src
2305
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002306 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2307 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309 Example:
2310 peers mypeers
2311 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2312 default-server ssl verify none
2313 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2314 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002315
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002316
2317table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2318 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2319
2320 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2321 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002322 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002323 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2324 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2325 "stick-table" keyword).
2326
2327 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2328 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2329 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2330 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2331 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2332 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2333 of the stick-table name as follows:
2334
2335 peers mypeers
2336 peer A ...
2337 peer B ...
2338 table t1 ...
2339
2340 frontend fe1
2341 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2342
2343 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2344 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2345
2346 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2347 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2348 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2349 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2350 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2351 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2352 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2353
2354 peers mypeers
2355 peer A ...
2356 peer B ...
2357 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2358
2359 backend t1
2360 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2361
2362 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2363 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2364 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2365
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023663.6. Mailers
2367------------
2368It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2369If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2370in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2371
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002372mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002373 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2374 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2375
2376mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2377 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2378
2379 Example:
2380 mailers mymailers
2381 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2382 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2383
2384 backend mybackend
2385 mode tcp
2386 balance roundrobin
2387
2388 email-alert mailers mymailers
2389 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2390 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2391
2392 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2393 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2394
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002395timeout mail <time>
2396 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2397 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2398 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2399 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2400
2401 Example:
2402 mailers mymailers
2403 timeout mail 20s
2404 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002405
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024063.7. Programs
2407-------------
2408In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2409master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2410managed the same way as the workers.
2411
2412During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2413sequence as a worker:
2414
2415 - the master is re-executed
2416 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2417 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2418 instance of the program
2419
2420During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2421
2422program <name>
2423 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2424 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2425 the management guide).
2426
2427command <command> [arguments*]
2428 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2429 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2430 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2431 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2432
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002433user <user name>
2434 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2435 See also "group".
2436
2437group <group name>
2438 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2439 See also "user".
2440
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002441option start-on-reload
2442no option start-on-reload
2443 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2444 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2445 program section.
2446
2447
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024483.8. HTTP-errors
2449----------------
2450
2451It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2452imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2453several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2454
2455http-errors <name>
2456 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2457 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2458
2459errorfile <code> <file>
2460 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2461
2462 Arguments :
2463 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2464 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2465 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2466
2467 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2468 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2469 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2470 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2471 before any chroot is performed.
2472
2473 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2474
2475 Example:
2476 http-errors website-1
2477 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2478 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2479 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2480
2481 http-errors website-2
2482 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2483 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2484 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2485
2486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002488----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002490Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002491 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002492 - frontend <name>
2493 - backend <name>
2494 - listen <name>
2495
2496A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2497its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2498section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002500
2501A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2502connections.
2503
2504A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2505to forward incoming connections.
2506
2507A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2508parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2511'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2512case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2513
2514Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2515logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2516proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2517However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2518name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2519
2520Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2521and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2524modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2525arbitrary criteria.
2526
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002527In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2528a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002529the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002530
2531 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2532 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2533 between responses and new requests.
2534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002535 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2536 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2537 client-facing connection remains open.
2538
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002539 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2540 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002541
2542The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2543frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2544following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002545weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002546
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002547 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002548
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002549 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2550 ----+-----+-----+----
2551 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2552 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002553 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2554 ----+-----+-----+----
2555 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2560--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002562The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2563limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2564they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2565limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002566marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002567option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002568and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2569with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2570specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002572
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002573 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2575acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576backlog X X X -
2577balance X - X X
2578bind - X X -
2579bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580capture cookie - X X -
2581capture request header - X X -
2582capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002583compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002584cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002585declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586default-server X - X X
2587default_backend X X X -
2588description - X X X
2589disabled X X X X
2590dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002591email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002592email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002593email-alert mailers X X X X
2594email-alert myhostname X X X X
2595email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002596enabled X X X X
2597errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002598errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002599errorloc X X X X
2600errorloc302 X X X X
2601-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2602errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002603force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002604filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002605fullconn X - X X
2606grace X X X X
2607hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002608http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002609http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002611http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002612http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002613http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002614http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002615http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002616id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002617ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002618load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002619log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002620log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002621log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002622log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002623max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002624maxconn X X X -
2625mode X X X X
2626monitor fail - X X -
2627monitor-net X X X -
2628monitor-uri X X X -
2629option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2630option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2631option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2632option allbackups (*) X - X X
2633option checkcache (*) X - X X
2634option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2635option contstats (*) X X X -
2636option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2637option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002638-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2639option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002640option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2641option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002642option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002643option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002644option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002645option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002646option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002647option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2648option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2649option httpchk X - X X
2650option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002651option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002653option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002654option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002655option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002656option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2657option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2658option logasap (*) X X X -
2659option mysql-check X - X X
2660option nolinger (*) X X X X
2661option originalto X X X X
2662option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002663option pgsql-check X - X X
2664option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002665option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002666option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667option smtpchk X - X X
2668option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2669option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2670option splice-request (*) X X X X
2671option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002672option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002673option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2674option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2675-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002676option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002677option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2678option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2679option tcpka X X X X
2680option tcplog X X X X
2681option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002682external-check command X - X X
2683external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2685rate-limit sessions X X X -
2686redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002687-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002688retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002689retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002690server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002691server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002692server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002694stats admin - X X X
2695stats auth X X X X
2696stats enable X X X X
2697stats hide-version X X X X
2698stats http-request - X X X
2699stats realm X X X X
2700stats refresh X X X X
2701stats scope X X X X
2702stats show-desc X X X X
2703stats show-legends X X X X
2704stats show-node X X X X
2705stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2707stick match - - X X
2708stick on - - X X
2709stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002710stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002711stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002712tcp-check connect - - X X
2713tcp-check expect - - X X
2714tcp-check send - - X X
2715tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002716tcp-request connection - X X -
2717tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002718tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002719tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002720tcp-response content - - X X
2721tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002722timeout check X - X X
2723timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002724timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002725timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002726timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2727timeout http-request X X X X
2728timeout queue X - X X
2729timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002730timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002731timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002732timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002734unique-id-format X X X -
2735unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002737use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002738use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2740 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2744---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745
2746This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2747
2748
2749acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2750 Declare or complete an access list.
2751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2752 no | yes | yes | yes
2753 Example:
2754 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2755 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2756 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002758 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002761backlog <conns>
2762 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2764 yes | yes | yes | no
2765 Arguments :
2766 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2767 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002768 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002769
2770 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2771 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2772 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2773 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2774 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2775 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2776 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2777 backlog parameter.
2778
2779 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2780 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2781 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2782
2783 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2784
2785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002787balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 yes | no | yes | yes
2791 Arguments :
2792 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2793 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2794 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2795 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2796
2797 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2798 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2799 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2800 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002801 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002802 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002803 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2804 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2805 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2806 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2807 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2808 it, so that you don't worry.
2809
2810 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2811 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2812 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2813 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2814 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2815 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2816 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2817 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002818
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002819 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2820 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2821 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2822 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2823 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2824 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2825 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2826 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2827
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002828 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002829 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002830 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2831 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002832 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002833 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2834 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2835 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2836 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2837 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002838 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2839 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2840 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2841 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2842 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2843 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2846 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2847 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2848 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2849 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2850 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2851 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2852 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002855 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2856 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2857 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002859 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2860 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2861 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2862 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2863 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2864 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2865 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2866 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2867 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2868 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2869 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2870 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002872 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002873 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2874 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2875 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2876 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2877 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2878 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2879 URIs start with a leading "/".
2880
2881 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2882 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2883 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2884 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002887 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2888
2889 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002890 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2891 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002892 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2893 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2894 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2895 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002896 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002897 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2898 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002899
2900 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2901 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2902 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2903 server will receive the request.
2904
2905 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2906 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2907 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2908 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2909 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002910 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2911 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2912 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002914 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2915 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2916 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2917 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2918 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002920 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002921 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2922 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2923 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2924
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002925 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2926 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2927 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2928
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002929 random
2930 random(<draws>)
2931 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002932 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2933 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2934 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2935 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002936 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2937 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2938 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2939 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2940 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2941 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2942 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2943 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2944 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2945 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2946 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2947 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2948 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2949 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2950 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2951 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2952 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2953 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2954 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2955 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002956
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002957 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002958 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002959 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2960 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2961 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2962 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2963 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2964 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002965 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002966 used instead.
2967
2968 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2969 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2970 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2971 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2972
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002973 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2974 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2975 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2976
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002977 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002980 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2981 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002982
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002983 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2984 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2985 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002987 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002988 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002989 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2990 NTLM relies on.
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 Examples :
2993 balance roundrobin
2994 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002995 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002996 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2997 balance hdr(host)
2998 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002999
3000 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3001 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003003 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003004 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3005 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3006 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003007 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003008
3009 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3010 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3011 defaults to 16 kB.
3012
3013 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3014 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3015
3016 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3017 Round Robin.
3018
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003019 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003020 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3021 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3022 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3023
3024 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3025
3026 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003027 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003028 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3029 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3030 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003032 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033
3034
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003035bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3036bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 no | yes | yes | no
3040 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003041 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3042 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3043 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3044 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003045 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003046 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3047 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3048 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3049 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3050 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3051 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3052 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003053 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3054 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3055 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3056 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3057 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3058 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3059 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003060 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3061 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3062 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003063 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3064 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3065 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3066 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003067 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3068 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3069 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003070
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003071 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3072 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003073 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3074 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3075 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003076 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3077 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3078 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3079 the range.
3080
3081 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3082 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3083 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3084 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3085 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3086 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3087 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003088 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003089 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003091 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003093 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3094 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3095 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3096 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3097 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3098 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003100 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3101 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3102 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3103 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3106 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3107 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3108 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3109 in a frontend.
3110
3111 Example :
3112 listen http_proxy
3113 bind :80,:443
3114 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003115 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003117 listen http_https_proxy
3118 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003119 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003120
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003121 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3122 bind ipv6@:80
3123 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3124 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003126 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003127 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003128
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003129 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3130 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3131 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3132 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3133 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3134
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003135 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003136 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137
3138
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003139bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003140 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143 Arguments :
3144 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3145 may be used to override a default value.
3146
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003147 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003148 option may be combined with other numbers.
3149
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003150 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003151 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3152 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3153 missing from all processes.
3154
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003155 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003156 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003157 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3158 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3159 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3160 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3161 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003162 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003163
3164 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3165 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3166 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3167 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3168 and 'even' instances.
3169
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003170 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3171 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3172 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3173 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003174
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003175 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3176 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3177
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003178 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3179 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3180 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3181
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003182 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3183 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3184
3185 Example :
3186 listen app_ip1
3187 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003188 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003189
3190 listen app_ip2
3191 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003192 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003193
3194 listen management
3195 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003196 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003198 listen management
3199 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3200 bind-process 1-4
3201
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003202 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203
3204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205capture cookie <name> len <length>
3206 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 no | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3211 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3212 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3213 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215
3216 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3217 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3218 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3219 right if it exceeds <length>.
3220
3221 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3222 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3223 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3224 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3225
3226 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3227 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3228 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3229
3230 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3231 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3232 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003233 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3234 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3235 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003236
3237 Example:
3238 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3239
3240 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003241 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242
3243
3244capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003245 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 no | yes | yes | no
3248 Arguments :
3249 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003250 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3252 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3253 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3254
3255 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3256 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3257 it exceeds <length>.
3258
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003259 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3261 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003262 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3263 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3264 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3265 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003266 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003267 environments to find where the request came from.
3268
3269 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3270 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3271 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3272 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003274 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3275 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3276 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3277 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3278 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
3280 Example:
3281 capture request header Host len 15
3282 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003283 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003285 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 about logging.
3287
3288
3289capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003290 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 no | yes | yes | no
3293 Arguments :
3294 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003295 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3297 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3298 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3299
3300 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3301 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3302 it exceeds <length>.
3303
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003304 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3306 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3307 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003308 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3309 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3310 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3311 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003312
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003313 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3314 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3315 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3316 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3317 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003318
3319 Example:
3320 capture response header Content-length len 9
3321 capture response header Location len 15
3322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003323 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324 about logging.
3325
3326
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003327compression algo <algorithm> ...
3328compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003329compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003330 Enable HTTP compression.
3331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | yes | yes | yes
3333 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003334 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3335 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3336 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3337
3338 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003339 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3340 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3341 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003342
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003343 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003344 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003345
3346 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3347 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3348 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3349 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3350 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003351 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003352
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003353 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3354 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3355 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3356 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3357 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3358 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3359 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003360 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003361
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003362 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003363 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003364 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3365 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3366 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3367 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3368 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003369
3370 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3371 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3372 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3373 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3374 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003375 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3376 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3377 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3378 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3379 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003380 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3381 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003382
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003383 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003384 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3385 "Accept-Encoding" header
3386 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003387 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003388 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3389 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3390 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3391 "multipart"
3392 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3393 header
3394 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3395 and later
3396 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3397 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003398 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003399
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003400 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003401
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003402 Examples :
3403 compression algo gzip
3404 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003406
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003407cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003408 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3409 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003410 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 yes | no | yes | yes
3414 Arguments :
3415 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3416 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3417 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3418 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3419 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3420 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3423 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3424
3425 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3426 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3427 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3428 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3429 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3430 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003431 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3432 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003433 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003434 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3435 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436
3437 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003438 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003439
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003440 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003442 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003443 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003444 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3445 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3446 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3447 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3448 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3449 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3450 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
3452 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3453 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3454 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3455 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3456 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3457 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3458 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3459 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3460 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003461 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003462 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3463 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3464 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003466 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3467 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3468 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003469 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3470 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3471 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3472 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003473 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3474 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3475 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
3477 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3478 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3479 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3480 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3481 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3482 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3483 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3484 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3485 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3486
3487 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3488 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3489 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3490 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3491 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3492 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3493 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3494 persistence cookie in the cache.
3495 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3496
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003497 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3498 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3499 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3500 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3501 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003503 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3504 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3505 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3506 they logout.
3507
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003508 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3509 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3510 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3511 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3512
3513 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3514 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3515 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3516 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3517 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3518 this attribute.
3519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003520 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003521 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003522 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3523 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3524 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3525 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3526 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3527 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003528
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003529 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3530 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3531 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3532 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3533 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3534 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3535 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3536 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003537 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003538 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3539 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3540 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3541 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3542 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3543 the site.
3544
3545 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3546 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3547 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3548 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3549 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3550 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3551 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3552 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3553 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3554 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3555 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3556 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3557 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003559 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3560 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3561
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003562 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3563 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3564 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3565 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3566 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3567 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3568
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003569 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3570 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3571 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3572 repeated.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3575 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3576 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3577 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 Examples :
3580 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3581 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3582 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003585 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003587
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003588declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3589 Declares a capture slot.
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 no | yes | yes | no
3592 Arguments:
3593 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3594
3595 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3596 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3597 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3598 for use in the response.
3599
3600 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003601 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003602 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3603
3604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003605default-server [param*]
3606 Change default options for a server in a backend
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | no | yes | yes
3609 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003610 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3611 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3612 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3613 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003614
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003615 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003616 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3617
3618 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621default_backend <backend>
3622 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | no
3625 Arguments :
3626 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3627
3628 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3629 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3630 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3631 will catch all undetermined requests.
3632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Example :
3634
3635 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3636 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3637 default_backend dynamic
3638
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003639 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003642description <string>
3643 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | yes
3646 Arguments : string
3647
3648 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3649 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3650 it describes.
3651 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3652
3653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654disabled
3655 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | yes | yes | yes
3658 Arguments : none
3659
3660 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3661 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3662 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3663 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3664 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3665 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3666 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3667
3668 See also : "enabled"
3669
3670
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003671dispatch <address>:<port>
3672 Set a default server address
3673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003675 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003676
3677 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3678 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3679 during start-up.
3680
3681 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3682 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3683 possible with normal servers.
3684
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003685 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003686 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3687 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3688 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3689 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3690
3691 See also : "server"
3692
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003693
3694dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3695 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | no | yes | yes
3698 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3699
3700 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003701 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003702 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3703 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003704 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003705 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707enabled
3708 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | yes
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3714 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3715
3716 See also : "disabled"
3717
3718
3719errorfile <code> <file>
3720 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723 Arguments :
3724 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003725 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3726 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003727
3728 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003729 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003730 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003731 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3732 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733
3734 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3735 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3736 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3737
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003738 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003740 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3741 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3742 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3743 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3744
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003745 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3746 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003748 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3749 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3750 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3753 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3754 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003755 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3757
3758 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3759
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003760 Example :
3761 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003762 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003763 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3764 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003766
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003767errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3768 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3769 section.
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments :
3773 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3774
3775 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3776 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3777 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3778
3779 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3780 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3781 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3782 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3783 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3784 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3785 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3786
3787 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3788 3.8 about http-errors.
3789
3790 Example :
3791 errorfiles generic
3792 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3793
3794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795errorloc <code> <url>
3796errorloc302 <code> <url>
3797 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3799 yes | yes | yes | yes
3800 Arguments :
3801 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003802 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3803 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003804
3805 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3806 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3807 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3808 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003809 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003810
3811 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3812 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3813 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3814
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003815 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003817 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3818 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3819 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3820 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003821 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003822 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3823 request.
3824
3825 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3826
3827
3828errorloc303 <code> <url>
3829 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | yes | yes | yes
3832 Arguments :
3833 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003834 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3835 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003836
3837 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3838 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3839 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3840 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003841 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003842
3843 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3844 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3845 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3846
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003847 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3850 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3851 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3852 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003853 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003854
3855 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3856
3857
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858email-alert from <emailaddr>
3859 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | yes | yes | yes
3863
3864 Arguments :
3865
3866 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3867
3868 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3869 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3870
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003871 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003872 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3873 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003874
3875
3876email-alert level <level>
3877 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3878 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881
3882 Arguments :
3883
3884 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3885 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3886 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3887
3888 By default level is alert
3889
3890 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3891 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3892 for the proxy.
3893
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003894 Alerts are sent when :
3895
3896 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3897 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3898 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3899 is notice or lower
3900 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3901 and a health check status update occurs
3902
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003903 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3904 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003905 section 3.6 about mailers.
3906
3907
3908email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3909 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912
3913 Arguments :
3914
3915 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3916
3917 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3918 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3919
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3921 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003922
3923
3924email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3925 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3926 mailers.
3927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | yes
3929
3930 Arguments :
3931
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003932 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003933
3934 By default the systems hostname is used.
3935
3936 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3937 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3938 for the proxy.
3939
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003940 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3941 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003942
3943
3944email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003945 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003946 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3948 yes | yes | yes | yes
3949
3950 Arguments :
3951
3952 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3953
3954 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3955 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003958 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3959
3960
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003961force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3962 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003964 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003965
3966 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3967 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3968 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3969 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3970 marked down for maintenance operations.
3971
3972 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3973 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3974 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3975 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3976 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3977 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3978 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3979 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3980 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3981
3982 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3983 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3984 is used.
3985
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003986 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003987 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003988
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003989
3990filter <name> [param*]
3991 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 no | yes | yes | yes
3994 Arguments :
3995 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3996 referenced in section 9.
3997
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003998 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003999 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004000 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4001 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004002
4003 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4004 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4005
4006 Example:
4007 listen
4008 bind *:80
4009
4010 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4011 filter compression
4012 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4013
4014 compression algo gzip
4015 compression offload
4016
4017 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4018
4019 See also : section 9.
4020
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004022fullconn <conns>
4023 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
4027 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4028 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4029
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004030 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004031 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004032 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4034 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4035 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4036 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4037 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004038 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004039
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004040 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4041 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004042 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4043 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4044 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004045
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004046 Example :
4047 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4048 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4049 # connections.
4050 backend dynamic
4051 fullconn 10000
4052 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4053 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4054
4055 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4056
4057
4058grace <time>
4059 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004062 Arguments :
4063 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4064 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4065 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4066
4067 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4068 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004069 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004070 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4071
4072 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4073 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4074 simplify it.
4075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004077hash-balance-factor <factor>
4078 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | no | no | yes
4081 Arguments :
4082 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4083 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004084 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004085
4086 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4087 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4088 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4089 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4090 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4091 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4092 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4093
4094 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4095 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4096 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4097 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4098 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4099
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004100 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4101 consistent hashing mechanism.
4102
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004103 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4104
4105
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004106hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | no | yes | yes
4110 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004111 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4112 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004113
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004114 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4115 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4116 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4117 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4118 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4119 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4120 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4121 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4122 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4123 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004124
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004125 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4126 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4127 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4128 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4129 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4130 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4131 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4132 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4133 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4134 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4135 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4136 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4137 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004138 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4139 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004140
4141 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4142
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004143 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004144 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4145 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4146 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004147 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4148 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4149 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004150
4151 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4152 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004153 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4154 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4155 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4156 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4157
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004158 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4159 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4160 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4161 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4162 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4163 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4164 parameter.
4165
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004166 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4167 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4168 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4169 used on strings.
4170
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004171 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4172
4173 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4174 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4175 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4176 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4177 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4178 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4179 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4180 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4181 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4182 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4183 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4184 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004185
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004186 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4187 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4188 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004189
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004190 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004191
4192
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004193http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4194 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4195 ones).
4196
4197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 no | yes | yes | yes
4199
4200 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4201 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4202 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4203 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4204 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4205 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4206
4207 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4208 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4209 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4210
4211 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4212 below.
4213
4214 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4215 instance.
4216
4217 Example:
4218 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4219 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4220 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4221
4222http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4223
4224 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4225 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4226 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4227 example, or to pass some internal information.
4228 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4229 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4230 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4231
4232http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4233
4234 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4235 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4236
4237http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4238
4239 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4240
4241http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4242 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4243
4244 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4245
4246 Example:
4247 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4248
4249 # applied to:
4250 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4251
4252 # outputs:
4253 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4254
4255 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4256
4257http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4259
4260 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4261
4262 Example:
4263 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4264
4265 # applied to:
4266 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4267
4268 # outputs:
4269 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4270
4271http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4272
4273 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4274 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4275 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4276
4277http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4278 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4281 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4282 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4283 fallback.
4284
4285 Example:
4286 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4287 http-response set-status 431
4288 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4289 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4290
4291http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4294 inline.
4295
4296 Arguments:
4297 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4298 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4299 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4302 (request and response)
4303 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4304 processing
4305 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4306 processing
4307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4308 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4309 and '_'.
4310
4311 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4312 followed by some converters.
4313
4314 Example:
4315 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4316
4317http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4318
4319 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4320 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4321 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4322 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4323 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4324 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
4325 processing.
4326
4327 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4328 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4329 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4330 rules evaluation.
4331
4332http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4335 details about <var-name>.
4336
4337 Example:
4338 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4339
4340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341http-check disable-on-404
4342 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345 Arguments : none
4346
4347 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4348 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4349 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4350 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4351 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4352 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4353 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4354 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004355 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4356 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4357 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4358
4359 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4360
4361
4362http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004363 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004365 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004366 Arguments :
4367 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4368 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004369 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004370 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4371 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4372 details on the supported keywords.
4373
4374 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4375 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4376 with the usual backslash ('\').
4377
4378 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4379 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4380 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4381 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4382 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4383
4384 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004385 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004386 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4387 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4388 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4389
4390 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004391 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004392 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4393 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4394 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4395 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4396
4397 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004398 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004399 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4400 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4401 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4402 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4403 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004404 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004405 trace).
4406
4407 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004409 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4410 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4411 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4412 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4413 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004414 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004415
4416 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4417 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4418 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4419 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4420 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4421 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4422 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4423 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4424
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004425 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4426 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4427 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4428
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004429 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4430 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4431
4432 Examples :
4433 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004434 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004435
4436 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004437 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004438
4439 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004440 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004441
4442 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004443 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004444
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004445 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
4447
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004448http-check send-state
4449 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | no | yes | yes
4452 Arguments : none
4453
4454 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4455 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4456 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4457 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4458 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4459
4460 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4461 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4462 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4463 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4464 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004465 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4466 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4467 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4468
4469 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4470 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4471 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4472
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004473 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4474 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4475 checked in multiple backends.
4476
4477 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4478 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4479
4480 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4481 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4482 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4483 one fails.
4484
4485 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4486 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4487 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4488
4489 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4490 server's queue.
4491
4492 Example of a header received by the application server :
4493 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4494 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4495
4496 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498
4499http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004500 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4501
4502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 no | yes | yes | yes
4504
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004505 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4506 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4507 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4508 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4509 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4512 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 Example:
4517 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4518 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4519 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521 http-request allow if nagios
4522 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4523 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4524 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526 Example:
4527 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4528 acl add path /addacl
4529 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4534 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Example:
4537 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4538 acl setmap path /setmap
4539 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4544 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4547 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004551 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4552 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4553 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4554 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4555 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4556 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4557 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4558 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4563 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4564 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4565 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4566 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4567 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4568 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4569 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4574 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004575
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4580 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4581 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4582 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4583 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585 Example:
4586 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4587 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004589http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004590
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004591 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4594 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4597 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4598 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4599 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4600 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4601 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4602 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4603 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4604 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4607 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4608 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004609 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4610
4611 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4612 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4613 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4614 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4619 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4620 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4621 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4622 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4623 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4632 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4633 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4634 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4635 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4636 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004637
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004638http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4642 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4643 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004644 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4645 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4646 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4647 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4648 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004650
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004651http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4652 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4653 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4654 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4655
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004656http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4657
4658 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4659 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4660 pointed by <resolvers>.
4661 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4662 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4663 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4664 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4665 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4666 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4667 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4668 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4669 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4670 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4671 to 0.0.0.0.
4672
4673 Example:
4674 resolvers mydns
4675 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4676 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4677 timeout retry 1s
4678 hold valid 10s
4679 hold nx 3s
4680 hold other 3s
4681 hold obsolete 0s
4682 accepted_payload_size 8192
4683
4684 frontend fe
4685 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4686 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4687 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4688
4689 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4690 # which mean DNS resolution error
4691 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4692
4693 default_backend be
4694
4695 backend b_503
4696 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4697 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4698 # 503 error page to end users
4699
4700 backend be
4701 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4702 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4703 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4704 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4705 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4706
4707 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4708 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4709
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004710http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4711
4712 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4713 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4714 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4715 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004716 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4717 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004718
4719 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4724 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4725 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4726 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4727 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004729http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004731 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4732 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4733 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4734 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004738
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004739 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4740 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4741 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4742 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4743 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4744 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004745
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004746 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4747 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4748 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4749 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4750 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004751
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004752 Example:
4753 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4754
4755 # applied to:
4756 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4757
4758 # outputs:
4759 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4760
4761 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004762
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004763 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4764
4765 # applied to:
4766 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004767
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004768 # outputs:
4769 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004770
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004771http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4773
4774 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4775 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4776 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4777 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4778
4779 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4780 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4781 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4782
4783 Example:
4784 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4785 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4786
4787 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4788 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4789
4790 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4791 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4792 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4793 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4794
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004795http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4796 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4797
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004798 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4799 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4800 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4801 against.
4802
4803 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4804 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4805 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004806
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004807 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4808 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4809 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4810 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4811 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4812 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4813 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4814 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4815 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004816 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4817 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004818
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004819 Example:
4820 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4821 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004822
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004823 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4824 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4827 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004828
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004829 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4830 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4831 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4832 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004833
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004834 Example:
4835 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004836
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004837 # applied to:
4838 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004839
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004840 # outputs:
4841 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004842
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004843http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4844 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4845 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
4846 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4847
4848 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediatly returns a response. The
4849 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4850 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4851 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4852 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
4853 or the response payload specifing the file or the string to use. These rules
4854 are followed to create the response :
4855
4856 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4857 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4858 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4859 ignored.
4860
4861 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4862 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4863 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4864 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4865 ignored.
4866
4867 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4868 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4869 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4870 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4871 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4872
4873 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4874 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4875 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4876 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4877 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4878 if any, is ignored.
4879
4880 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4881 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4882 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4883 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4884 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4885 as a raw content.
4886
4887 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4888 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4889 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4890 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4891 considered as a raw string.
4892
4893 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4894 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4895 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4896
4897 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4898
4899 Example:
4900 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4901 if { path /ping }
4902
4903 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4904 if { path /favicon.ico }
4905
4906 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4907 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4908 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004910http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4911http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004913 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4914 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4915 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004916
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004917http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4918 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004919
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004920 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4921 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4922 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4923 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004925http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004927 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4928 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4929 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4930 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4931 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004933 Arguments:
4934 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4935 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004937 Example:
4938 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4939 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004941 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4942 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004943
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004944http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004946 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4947 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4948 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004950 Arguments:
4951 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4952 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004954 Example:
4955 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4956 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004958 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4959 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4960 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004962http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004963
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004964 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4965 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4966 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4967 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4968 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004970 Example:
4971 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4972 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4973 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4974 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4975 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4976 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4977 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4978 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4979 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004981http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004983 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4984 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4985 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4986 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4987 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4990 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004992 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4993 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4994 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4995 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4996 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4997 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4998 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4999 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5000 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005002http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005004 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5005 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5006 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5007 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5008 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5009 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5010 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005012http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5015 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5016 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005018http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005020 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5021 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5022 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5023 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5024 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5025 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5026 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5027 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005029http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005031 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5032 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5033 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5034 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5035 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5036 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005038 Example :
5039 # prepend the host name before the path
5040 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005042http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5045 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5046 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5047 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5048 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005050http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005052 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5053 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5054 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5055 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5056 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5057 values have higher priority.
5058 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5059 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5060 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5061 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5062 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005066 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5067 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5068 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5069 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5070 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5071 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5072 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005074 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005075
5076 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005077 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5078 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005080http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5081 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5082 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5083 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
5084 privacy.
5085
5086 Arguments :
5087 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5088 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005089
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005090 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5092 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5093
5094 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5095 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5096
5097http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5098
5099 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5100 expression.
5101
5102 Arguments:
5103 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5104 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005105
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005106 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005107 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5108 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5109
5110 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5111 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5112 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5113
5114http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5115
5116 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5117 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5118 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5119 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5120 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5121 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5122 information from the request.
5123
5124 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5125
5126http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5127
5128 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5129 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5130 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5131 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5132 path and the query string.
5133 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5134
5135http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5136
5137 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5138 inline.
5139
5140 Arguments:
5141 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5142 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5143 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5144 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5145 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5146 (request and response)
5147 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5148 processing
5149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5150 processing
5151 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5152 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5153 and '_'.
5154
5155 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5156 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005157
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005158 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005161http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5162 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005164 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5165 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5166 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5167 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5168 agent name must be used.
5169
5170 Arguments:
5171 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5172
5173 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5174 configuration.
5175
5176http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5177
5178 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5179 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5180 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5181 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5182 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5183 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5184 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5185 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5186 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5187 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5188 action.
5189 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5190 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5191 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5192 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5193 you fully understand how it works.
5194
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005195http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5196
5197 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5198 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5199 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5200 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5201 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5202 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
5203 processing.
5204
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005205 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005206 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5207 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5208 rules evaluation.
5209
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005210http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5211 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005212
5213 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5214 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5215 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5216 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5217 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5218 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5219 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5220 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5221 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5222 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5223 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005224 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5225 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5226 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5227 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5228 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005229 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5230
5231http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5232http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5233http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5234
5235 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5236 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5237 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5238 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5239 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5240 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5241 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5242 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5243 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5244 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5245 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5246 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5247
5248 Arguments :
5249 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5250 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5251 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5252 select which table entry to update the counters.
5253
5254 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5255 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5256 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5257 that table until the session ends.
5258
5259 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5260 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5261 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5262 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5263 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5264 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5265 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5266 useful information.
5267
5268 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5269 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5270 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5271 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5272 checks that make use of it.
5273
5274http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5275
5276 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005277
5278 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005279 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005280
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005281http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5282
5283 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5284 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5285 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5286 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5287 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5288 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5289
5290 Arguments :
5291 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5292
5293 Example:
5294 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005296http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005298 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5299 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5300 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005301
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005303http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005304 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5305
5306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5307 no | yes | yes | yes
5308
5309 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5310 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5311 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5312 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5313 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5314 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005316 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5317 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005319 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005321 Example:
5322 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005324 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005326 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5327 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005329 Example:
5330 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005331
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005332 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005334 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5335 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005337 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5338 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005340http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005341
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005342 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5343 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5344 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5345 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5346 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5347 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5348 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5349 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005351http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005353 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5354 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5355 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5356 example, or to pass some internal information.
5357 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5358 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5359 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005361http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005363 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5364 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005365
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005366http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005367
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005368 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005369
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005370http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005371
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005372 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5373 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5374 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5375 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5376 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5377 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5378 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005380 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5381 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5382 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5383 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5384 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005385
5386 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5387 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5388 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5389 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005391http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005392
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005393 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5394 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5395 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5396 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5397 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5398 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005400http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005402 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005404http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005405
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005406 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5407 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5408 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5409 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5410 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5411 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005412
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005413http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005415
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005416 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005417 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5418 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005419 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5420 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5421 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5422 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5423 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005424 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005428 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5429 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5430 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5431 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5432 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5433 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005435http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5436 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005438 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5439 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005441 Example:
5442 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005444 # applied to:
5445 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005447 # outputs:
5448 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005450 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005452http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5453 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005454
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005455 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005456 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005458 Example:
5459 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 # applied to:
5462 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005464 # outputs:
5465 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005466
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005467http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5468 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5469 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5470 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5471
5472 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediatly returns a response. The
5473 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5474 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5475 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5476 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
5477 or the response payload specifing the file or the string to use. These rules
5478 are followed to create the response :
5479
5480 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5481 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5482 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5483 ignored.
5484
5485 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5486 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5487 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5488 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5489 ignored.
5490
5491 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5492 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5493 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5494 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5495 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5496
5497 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5498 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5499 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5500 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5501 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5502 if any, is ignored.
5503
5504 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5505 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5506 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5507 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5508 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5509 as a raw content.
5510
5511 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5512 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5513 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5514 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5515 considered as a raw string.
5516
5517 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5518 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5519 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5520
5521 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5522
5523 Example:
5524 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5525 if { status eq 404 }
5526
5527 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5528 string "This is the end !" \
5529 if { status eq 500 }
5530
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005531http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5532http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005533
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005534 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5535 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5536 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005537
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005538http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005540
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005541 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5542 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5543 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5544 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005545
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005546http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005547
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005548 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5549 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5550 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5551 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5552 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005553
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005554 Arguments:
5555 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005556
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005557 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5558 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005560http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005562 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5563 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5564 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005566http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5567
5568 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5569 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5570 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5571 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5572 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5573
5574http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5575
5576 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5577 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5578 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5579 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5580 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5581 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5582 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5583 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5584 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5585
5586http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5587
5588 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5589 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5590 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5591 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5592 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5593 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5594 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5595
5596http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5597
5598 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5599 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5600 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5601 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5602 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5603 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5604 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5605 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5606
5607http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5608 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5609
5610 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5611 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5612 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5613 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005614
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005615 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005616 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5617 http-response set-status 431
5618 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5619 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005620
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005621http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005623 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5624 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5625 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5626 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5627 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5628 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5629 based on some information from the request.
5630
5631 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5632
5633http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5634
5635 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5636 inline.
5637
5638 Arguments:
5639 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5640 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5644 (request and response)
5645 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5646 processing
5647 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5648 processing
5649 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5650 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5651 and '_'.
5652
5653 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5654 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005655
5656 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005657 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005659http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005661 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5662 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5663 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5664 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5665 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5666 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5667 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5668 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5669 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5670 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5671 action.
5672 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5673 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5674 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5675 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5676 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005677
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005678http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5679
5680 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5681 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5682 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5683 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5684 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5685 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5686 processing.
5687
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005688 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005689 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5690 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5691 rules evaluation.
5692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005693http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5694http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5695http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005697 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5698 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5699 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5700 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5701 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5702 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5703
5704http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5705
5706 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5707 about <var-name>.
5708
5709 Example:
5710 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5711
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005712
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005713http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5714 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5715
5716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 yes | no | yes | yes
5718
5719 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005720 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5721 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5722 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005723
5724 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5725
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005726 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5727 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5728 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5729 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5730 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5731 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5732 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5733 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5734 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5735 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005736
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005737 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5738 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5739 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5740 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5741 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5742 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5743 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5744 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005745
5746 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5747 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5748 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5749 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5750 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5751 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5752 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5753 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005754 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005755 downsides of rare connection failures.
5756
5757 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5758 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5759 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5760 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5761 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5762 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005763 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005764 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5765 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5766 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5767 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5768 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5769
5770 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005771 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5772 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5773 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005774
5775 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005776 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005777
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005778 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5779 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005780
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005781 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005782
5783 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5784 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5785 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5786
5787 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5788
5789
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005790http-send-name-header [<header>]
5791 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5793 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005794 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005795 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5796
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005797 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5798 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5799 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5800 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5801 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5802 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5803 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5804 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5805 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5806 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5807 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5808 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5809 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5810 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5811 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5812 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005813
5814 See also : "server"
5815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005816id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005817 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 no | yes | yes | yes
5820 Arguments : none
5821
5822 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5823 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5824 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005825
5826
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005827ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5828 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005830 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005831
5832 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5833 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5834 and running).
5835
5836 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5837 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5838 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005839 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005840 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5841
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005842 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5843 "unless" condition is met.
5844
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005845 Example:
5846 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5847 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5848 ignore-persist if url_static
5849
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005850 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5851
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005852load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5853 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 yes | no | yes | yes
5856
5857 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5858 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5859 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005860 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005861 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5862 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5863 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5864 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5865
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005866 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005867 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005868 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005869
5870 Arguments:
5871 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5872 named "server-state-file".
5873
5874 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5875 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5876 name is used as a file name.
5877
5878 none don't load any stat for this backend
5879
5880 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005881 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5882 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5883 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005884 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005885 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005886
5887 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5888 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5889
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005890 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005891
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005892 global
5893 stats socket /tmp/socket
5894 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005895
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005896 defaults
5897 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005898
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005899 backend bk
5900 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5901 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005902
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005903
5904 Then one can run :
5905
5906 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5907
5908 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5909
5910 1
5911 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5912 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5913 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5914
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005915 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005916
5917 global
5918 stats socket /tmp/socket
5919 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5920
5921 defaults
5922 load-server-state-from-file local
5923
5924 backend bk
5925 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5926 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5927
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005928
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005929 Then one can run :
5930
5931 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5932
5933 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5934
5935 1
5936 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5937 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5938 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5939
5940 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5941 "show servers state"
5942
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005943
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005944log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005945log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5946 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005947no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005948 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005951
5952 Prefix :
5953 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5954 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5955 prefix does not allow arguments.
5956
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005957 Arguments :
5958 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5959 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5960 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5961 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5962 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5963 parameter.
5964
5965 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5966 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5967
5968 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5969 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5970 standard syslog port).
5971
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005972 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5973 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5974 standard syslog port).
5975
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005976 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5977 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5978 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005979 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005980
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005981 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5982 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5983 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5984 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5985 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5986 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5987 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5988 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5989 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5990 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5991 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5992 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5993 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5994 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5995 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5996 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005997 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5998 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005999
6000 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6001 and "fd@2", see above.
6002
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006003 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6004 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6005 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6006 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6007 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6008 having the logs instantly available.
6009
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006010 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6011 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006012
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006013 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6014 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6015 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6016 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6017 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6018 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6019 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6020 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6021 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6022 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006023 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006024
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006025 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6026 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6027 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6028 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6029 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6030
6031 <sample_size>
6032 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6033 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6034 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6035 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6036 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6037
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006038 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6039 one of the following :
6040
6041 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6042 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6043
6044 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6045 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6046
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006047 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6048 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6049 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6050 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6051 systemd logger consumes.
6052
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006053 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6054 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6055 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6056 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6057
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006058 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6059
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006060 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6061 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6062 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6063
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006064 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6065 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6066 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6067 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006068
6069 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6070 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6071 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006072 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6073 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6074 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6075 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6076 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006077
6078 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6079
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006080 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6081 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6082 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006083
6084 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6085 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6086 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6087 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6088
6089 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6090 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006091
6092 Example :
6093 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006094 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6095 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6096 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006097 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6098 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006099 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006100
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006101
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006102log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006103 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6105 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006106
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006107 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6108 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6109 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6110 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6111 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006112
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006113 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6114 "option httplog" directives.
6115
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006116log-format-sd <string>
6117 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6118 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | yes | yes | no
6120
6121 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6122 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6123 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6124 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6125 which covers the log format string in depth.
6126
6127 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6128 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6129
6130 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6131 log format to "rfc5424".
6132
6133 Example :
6134 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6135
6136
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006137log-tag <string>
6138 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6139 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6140 yes | yes | yes | yes
6141
6142 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6143 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6144 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6145 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6146 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6147 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6148 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6149 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6150 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006151
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006152max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6153 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6155 yes | no | yes | yes
6156
6157 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6158 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6159 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6160 servers.
6161
6162 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6163 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6164 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6165 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6166 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006167 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006168 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6169 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6170 picking a different server.
6171
6172 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6173 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6174 even if they have to be queued.
6175
6176 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6177 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6178
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006179max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6180 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6181 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6182 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006183
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006184maxconn <conns>
6185 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6187 yes | yes | yes | no
6188 Arguments :
6189 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6190 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6191 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6192 closes.
6193
6194 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6195 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6196 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6197 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006198 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6199 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6200 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6201 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006202
6203 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6204 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6205 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6206
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006207 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6208 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006210 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6211
6212
6213mode { tcp|http|health }
6214 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6216 yes | yes | yes | yes
6217 Arguments :
6218 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6219 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6220 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6221 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6222
6223 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6224 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6225 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6226 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6227 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6228
6229 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006230 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6231 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6232 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6233 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6234 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6235 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6236 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006238 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6239 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6240 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006241
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006242 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006243 defaults http_instances
6244 mode http
6245
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006246 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006249monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006250 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006253 Arguments :
6254 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6255 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006256 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006257 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6258 backend and its backup.
6259
6260 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6261 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6262 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6263 servers in a list of backends.
6264
6265 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6266 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6267 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6268 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6269 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6270 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6271 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006272 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6273 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006274
6275 Example:
6276 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006277 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006278 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6279 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6280 monitor-uri /site_alive
6281 monitor fail if site_dead
6282
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006283 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006284
6285
6286monitor-net <source>
6287 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | yes | yes | no
6290 Arguments :
6291 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6292 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6293 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6294 followed by a mask.
6295
6296 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6297 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006298 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006299 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6300
6301 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6302 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6303 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6304 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006305 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6306 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6307 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006308
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006309 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6310 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6311 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6312 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6313 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6314 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006315
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006316 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6317 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006318
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006319 Example :
6320 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6321 frontend www
6322 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6323
6324 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6325
6326
6327monitor-uri <uri>
6328 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 yes | yes | yes | no
6331 Arguments :
6332 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6333 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6334
6335 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6336 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6337 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6338 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6339 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6340 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6341 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6342 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6343
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006344 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006345 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6346 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6347 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6348 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6349 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6350 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006351
6352 Example :
6353 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6354 frontend www
6355 mode http
6356 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6357
6358 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006360
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006361option abortonclose
6362no option abortonclose
6363 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 yes | no | yes | yes
6366 Arguments : none
6367
6368 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6369 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6370 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6371 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006372 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006373 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6374 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6375 encountered while delivering the response.
6376
6377 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6378 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6379 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6380 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6381 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6382 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006383 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006384 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006385 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006386 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6387 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6388 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6389
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006390 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6391 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006392 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6393 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6394 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6395 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6396 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6397 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006398 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006399
6400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6402
6403 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6404
6405
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006406option accept-invalid-http-request
6407no option accept-invalid-http-request
6408 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6410 yes | yes | yes | no
6411 Arguments : none
6412
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006413 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006414 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006415 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006416 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6417 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6418 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6419 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6420 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006421 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6422 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6423 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6424 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006425 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006426 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006427 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6428 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6429 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006430
6431 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6432 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6433 been confirmed.
6434
6435 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6436 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006437 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6438 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006439 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6440
6441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6443
6444 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6445 stats socket.
6446
6447
6448option accept-invalid-http-response
6449no option accept-invalid-http-response
6450 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6452 yes | no | yes | yes
6453 Arguments : none
6454
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006455 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006456 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006457 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006458 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6459 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6460 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6461 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6462 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006463 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6464 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6465 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006466
6467 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6468 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6469 been confirmed.
6470
6471 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6472 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6473 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6474 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6475
6476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6478
6479 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6480 stats socket.
6481
6482
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006483option allbackups
6484no option allbackups
6485 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6487 yes | no | yes | yes
6488 Arguments : none
6489
6490 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6491 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6492 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6493 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6494 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6495 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6496 order between the backup servers anymore.
6497
6498 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6499 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6500
6501 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6502 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6503
6504
6505option checkcache
6506no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006507 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6509 yes | no | yes | yes
6510 Arguments : none
6511
6512 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6513 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006514 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006515 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6516 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006517 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006518
6519 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006520 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006521 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006522 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6523 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006524 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006525 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006526 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6527 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006528 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006529 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6530 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006531 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006532 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6533 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6534 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6535 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6536 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6537 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6538 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6539 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6540 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6541
6542 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006543 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6544 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6545 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6546 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006547
6548 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6549 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006550 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006551 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006552
6553 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6554 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6555
6556
6557option clitcpka
6558no option clitcpka
6559 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 yes | yes | yes | no
6562 Arguments : none
6563
6564 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6565 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006566 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006567 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6568
6569 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6570 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6571 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6572 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6573
6574 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6575 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6576 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6577 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6578 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6579
6580 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6581
6582 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6583 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6584 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6585
6586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6588
6589 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6590
6591
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006592option contstats
6593 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6595 yes | yes | yes | no
6596 Arguments : none
6597
6598 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6599 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6600 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6601 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006602 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6603 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6604 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6605 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6606 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006607
6608
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006609option dontlog-normal
6610no option dontlog-normal
6611 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | yes | yes | no
6614 Arguments : none
6615
6616 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6617 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6618 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6619 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6620 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6621 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6622 logged.
6623
6624 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6625 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6626 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006628 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006629 logging.
6630
6631
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006632option dontlognull
6633no option dontlognull
6634 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6636 yes | yes | yes | no
6637 Arguments : none
6638
6639 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6640 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6641 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6642 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6643 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6644 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006645 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6646 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6647 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006648
6649 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006650 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006651 would not be logged.
6652
6653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6655
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006656 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6657 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006658
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006659
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006660option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006661 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6663 yes | yes | yes | yes
6664 Arguments :
6665 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6666 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006667 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006668 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006669
6670 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6671 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6672 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6673 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6674 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6675 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6676 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006677 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6678 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6679 possible that the client has already brought one.
6680
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006681 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006682 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006683 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006684 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006685 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006686 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006687
6688 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6689 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6690 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6691 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6692 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6693 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6694 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6695
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006696 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6697 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6698 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6699 are under the control of the end-user.
6700
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006701 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006702 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6703 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006704 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6705 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6706 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006707
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006708 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006709 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6710 frontend www
6711 mode http
6712 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6713
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006714 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6715 backend www
6716 mode http
6717 option forwardfor header X-Client
6718
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006719 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006720 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006721
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006722
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006723option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6724no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6725 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6727 yes | yes | yes | no
6728 Arguments : none
6729
6730 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6731 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6732 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6733 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6734 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6735 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6736 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6737
6738 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6739 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6740 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6741 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6742 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6743 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6744 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6745 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6746 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6747 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6748
6749 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6750
6751 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6752 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6753
6754 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6755 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6756
6757
6758option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6759no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6760 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 yes | no | yes | yes
6763 Arguments : none
6764
6765 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6766 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6767 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6768 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6769 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6770 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6771 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6772
6773 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6774 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6775 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6776 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6777 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6778 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6779 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6780 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6781 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6782 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6783
6784 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6785
6786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6788
6789 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6790 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6791
6792
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006793option http-buffer-request
6794no option http-buffer-request
6795 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6797 yes | yes | yes | yes
6798 Arguments : none
6799
6800 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6801 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6802 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6803 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6804 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6805 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006806 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6807 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6808 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6809 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006810
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006811 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006812
6813
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006814option http-ignore-probes
6815no option http-ignore-probes
6816 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 yes | yes | yes | no
6819 Arguments : none
6820
6821 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6822 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6823 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6824 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6825 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6826 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6827 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6828 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6829 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006830 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6831 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006832 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6833
6834 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6835 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6836 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6837 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6838 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6839 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6840 are often the only way to detect them.
6841
6842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6844
6845 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6846
6847
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006848option http-keep-alive
6849no option http-keep-alive
6850 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6852 yes | yes | yes | yes
6853 Arguments : none
6854
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006855 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6856 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006857 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6858 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006859 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6860 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6861 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006862
6863 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6864 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006865 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6866 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6867 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6868 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6869 situations where this option may be useful :
6870
6871 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006872 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006873
6874 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6875 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6876
6877 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6878 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6879 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6880 request.
6881
6882 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6883 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006884 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6885 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6886 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006887
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006888 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6889 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6890 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6891 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6892 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6893 not set.
6894
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006895 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6896 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6897 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006898
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006899 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006900 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006901 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006902
6903
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006904option http-no-delay
6905no option http-no-delay
6906 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6908 yes | yes | yes | yes
6909 Arguments : none
6910
6911 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6912 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6913 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6914 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6915 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6916 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6917 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6918 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6919 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6920 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6921 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6922 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6923 affected.
6924
6925 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6926 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6927 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6928 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6929 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6930 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6931 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6932 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6933 latency environments.
6934
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006935 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6936
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006937
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006938option http-pretend-keepalive
6939no option http-pretend-keepalive
6940 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006942 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006943 Arguments : none
6944
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006945 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006946 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6947 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6948 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6949 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6950 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6951 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6952 consider the response complete.
6953
6954 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6955 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6956 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6957 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006958 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006959 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6960
6961 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6962 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6963 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6964 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6965 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6966 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6967 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6968
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006969 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6970 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6971 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6972 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6973 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6974 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006975
6976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6978
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006979 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006980 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006981
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006982
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006983option http-server-close
6984no option http-server-close
6985 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6987 yes | yes | yes | yes
6988 Arguments : none
6989
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006990 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6991 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6992 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6993 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006994 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6995 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6996 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6997 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6998 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6999 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7000 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7001 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7002 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7003 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7004 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007005
7006 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7007 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7008 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7009 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007010 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7011 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007012
7013 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7014 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007015 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7016 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7017 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007018
7019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7021
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007022 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7023 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007024
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007025option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007026no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007027 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7029 yes | yes | yes | no
7030 Arguments : none
7031
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007032 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007033 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7034 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7035 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7036 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7037 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7038 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7039
7040 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7041 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007042 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7043 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7044 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007045
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007046 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7047 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7048 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7049 front of an existing proxy.
7050
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007051 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7052
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007053 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007054
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007055option httpchk
7056option httpchk <uri>
7057option httpchk <method> <uri>
7058option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7059 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7061 yes | no | yes | yes
7062 Arguments :
7063 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7064 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7065 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7066 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7067 ones.
7068
7069 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7070 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7071 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7072
7073 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7074 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7075 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7076 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7077 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7078
7079 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7080 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7081 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7082 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7083 the lack of any response.
7084
7085 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7086
7087 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7088 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7089 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7090
7091 Examples :
7092 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7093 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7094 backend https_relay
7095 mode tcp
7096 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7097 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7098
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007099 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7100 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7101 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007102
7103
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007104option httpclose
7105no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007106 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 yes | yes | yes | yes
7109 Arguments : none
7110
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007111 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7112 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7113 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7114 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007115 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007116
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007117 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7118 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007119 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007120 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7121 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007122
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007123 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7124 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7125 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007126
7127 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7128 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007129 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7130 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7131 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007132
7133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7135
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007136 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007137
7138
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007139option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007140 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007142 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007143 Arguments :
7144 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7145 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7146 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007147 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007148 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007149
7150 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7151 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7152 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7153 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7154 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7155 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7156 ports.
7157
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007158 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7159 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007160
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007161 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007163 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007164
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007165
7166option http_proxy
7167no option http_proxy
7168 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7170 yes | yes | yes | yes
7171 Arguments : none
7172
7173 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7174 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7175 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7176 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7177 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7178
7179 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7180 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007181 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7182 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007183
7184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7186
7187 Example :
7188 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7189 backend direct_forward
7190 option httpclose
7191 option http_proxy
7192
7193 See also : "option httpclose"
7194
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007195
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007196option independent-streams
7197no option independent-streams
7198 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7200 yes | yes | yes | yes
7201 Arguments : none
7202
7203 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7204 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7205 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7206 receive data or not.
7207
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007208 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007209 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7210 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7211 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7212 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7213 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7214 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7215 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7216 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7217 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7218 socket buffers.
7219
7220 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7221 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7222 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7223 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7224 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7225
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007226 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007227
7228
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007229option ldap-check
7230 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | no | yes | yes
7233 Arguments : none
7234
7235 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7236 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7237 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7238 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7239
7240 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7241 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7242
7243 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7244 configure it.
7245
7246 Example :
7247 option ldap-check
7248
7249 See also : "option httpchk"
7250
7251
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007252option external-check
7253 Use external processes for server health checks
7254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7255 yes | no | yes | yes
7256
7257 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7258 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7259 command".
7260
7261 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7262
7263 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7264
7265
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007266option log-health-checks
7267no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007268 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | no | yes | yes
7271 Arguments : none
7272
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007273 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7274 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7275 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007276
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007277 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7278 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7279 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7280 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7281 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007283 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007284 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007285
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007286 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7287 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7288 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007289
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007290
7291option log-separate-errors
7292no option log-separate-errors
7293 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7295 yes | yes | yes | no
7296 Arguments : none
7297
7298 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7299 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7300 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7301 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7302 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7303 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7304 provides very important information.
7305
7306 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7307 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7308 error logs.
7309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007310 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007311 logging.
7312
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007313
7314option logasap
7315no option logasap
7316 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | yes | yes | no
7319 Arguments : none
7320
7321 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7322 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7323 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7324 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7325 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7326 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7327 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007328 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007329 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7330 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007332 Examples :
7333 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7334 mode http
7335 option httplog
7336 option logasap
7337 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7338
7339 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7340 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7341 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7342 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007344 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007345 logging.
7346
7347
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007348option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007349 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7351 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007352 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007353 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7354 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007355 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007356
7357 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7358 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007359 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007360 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7361 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7362 in the MySQL table, like this :
7363
7364 USE mysql;
7365 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7366 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7367
7368 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007369 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007370 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7371 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7372 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7373 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7374 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7375 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7376 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7377
7378 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7379 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007380
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007381 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007382
7383 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7384 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7385 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7386 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007387 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7388 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007389
7390 See also: "option httpchk"
7391
7392
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007393option nolinger
7394no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007395 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007398 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007399
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007400 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007401 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7402 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7403 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7404 connections.
7405
7406 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7407 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7408 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7409 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7410 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7411 this too.
7412
7413 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7414 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7415 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7416
7417 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7418 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7419 for servers.
7420
7421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7423
7424
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007425option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7426 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7428 yes | yes | yes | yes
7429 Arguments :
7430 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7431 matching <network>
7432 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7433 header name.
7434
7435 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7436 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7437 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7438 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7439 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7440 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7441 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7442 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7443 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7444 possible that the client has already brought one.
7445
7446 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7447 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7448 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7449 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7450 header and requires different one.
7451
7452 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7453 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7454 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7455 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7456 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7457 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7458 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7459
7460 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7461 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7462 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7463 both are defined.
7464
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007465 Examples :
7466 # Original Destination address
7467 frontend www
7468 mode http
7469 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7470
7471 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7472 backend www
7473 mode http
7474 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7475
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007476 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007477
7478
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007479option persist
7480no option persist
7481 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7483 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007484 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007485
7486 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7487 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7488 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7489 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7490 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7491 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7492 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7493 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7494 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7495 redirected to another valid server.
7496
7497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7499
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007500 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007501
7502
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007503option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7504 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7506 yes | no | yes | yes
7507 Arguments :
7508 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7509 PostgreSQL server.
7510
7511 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7512 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7513 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7514 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7515
7516 See also: "option httpchk"
7517
7518
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007519option prefer-last-server
7520no option prefer-last-server
7521 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7522 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7523 yes | no | yes | yes
7524 Arguments : none
7525
7526 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7527 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7528 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7529 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7530 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7531 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7532 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7533 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7534 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007535 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7536 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007537 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7538 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7539 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007540 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7541 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7542 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007543
7544 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7545 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7546
7547 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7548
7549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007550option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007551option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007552no option redispatch
7553 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7555 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007556 Arguments :
7557 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7558 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7559 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007560 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007561 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007562 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007563 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7564 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7565 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007567
7568 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7569 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7570 be able to access the service anymore.
7571
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007572 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7573 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007574
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007575 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007576 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7577 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7581
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007582 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007583
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007584
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007585option redis-check
7586 Use redis health checks for server testing
7587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7588 yes | no | yes | yes
7589 Arguments : none
7590
7591 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7592 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7593 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7594 find the "+PONG" response message.
7595
7596 Example :
7597 option redis-check
7598
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007599 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007600
7601
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007602option smtpchk
7603option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7604 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007607 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007608 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007609 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007610 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7611
7612 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7613 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7614 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7615
7616 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7617 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7618 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7619 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7620 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7621 dead server.
7622
7623 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7624 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007625 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007626 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7627
7628 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7629 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7630 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7631 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007632 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007633
7634 Example :
7635 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7636
7637 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007640option socket-stats
7641no option socket-stats
7642
7643 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7645 yes | yes | yes | no
7646
7647 Arguments : none
7648
7649
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007650option splice-auto
7651no option splice-auto
7652 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7654 yes | yes | yes | yes
7655 Arguments : none
7656
7657 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7658 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007659 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007660 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007661 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007662 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7663 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7664 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7665 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7666
7667 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7668 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7669 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7670 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7671 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7672 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7673 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7674 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7675 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7676 keyword.
7677
7678 Example :
7679 option splice-auto
7680
7681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7683
7684 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7685 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7686
7687
7688option splice-request
7689no option splice-request
7690 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | yes | yes | yes
7693 Arguments : none
7694
7695 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007696 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007697 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7698 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7699 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7700 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7701
7702 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7703
7704 Example :
7705 option splice-request
7706
7707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7709
7710 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7711 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7712
7713
7714option splice-response
7715no option splice-response
7716 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | yes | yes | yes
7719 Arguments : none
7720
7721 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007722 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007723 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7724 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7725 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7726 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7727
7728 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7729
7730 Example :
7731 option splice-response
7732
7733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7735
7736 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7737 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7738
7739
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007740option spop-check
7741 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 no | no | no | yes
7744 Arguments : none
7745
7746 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7747 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7748 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7749 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7750
7751 Example :
7752 option spop-check
7753
7754 See also : "option httpchk"
7755
7756
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007757option srvtcpka
7758no option srvtcpka
7759 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 yes | no | yes | yes
7762 Arguments : none
7763
7764 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7765 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007766 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007767 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7768
7769 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7770 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7771 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7772 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7773
7774 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7775 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7776 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7777 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7778 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7779
7780 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7781
7782 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7783 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7784 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7785
7786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7788
7789 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7790
7791
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007792option ssl-hello-chk
7793 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 yes | no | yes | yes
7796 Arguments : none
7797
7798 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7799 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7800 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7801 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7802 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7803 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7804 hello message.
7805
7806 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7807 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7808 messages, which is appreciable.
7809
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007810 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7811 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7812 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007813
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007814 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7815
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007816
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007817option tcp-check
7818 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7820 yes | no | yes | yes
7821
7822 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7823 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7824
7825 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7826 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7827 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7828
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007829 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007830 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7831 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7832 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7833 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7834 only.
7835
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007836 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007837 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7838 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7839 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7840 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007842 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007843 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7844 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007845 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007846 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7847 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7848 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7849 the respective protocols.
7850 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007851 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007852
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007853 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7854 script.
7855
7856 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7857 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7858 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7859 The "comment" is of course optional.
7860
7861
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007862 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007863 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007864 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007865 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007866
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007867 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007868 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007869 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007870
7871 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7872 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007873 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007874 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007875 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007876 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007877 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007878 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007879 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7880 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007881 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007882 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7883 tcp-check expect string +OK
7884
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007885 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007886 (send many headers before analyzing)
7887 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007888 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007889 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7890 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7891 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7892 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007893 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007894
7895
7896 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7897
7898
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007899option tcp-smart-accept
7900no option tcp-smart-accept
7901 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 yes | yes | yes | no
7904 Arguments : none
7905
7906 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7907 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7908 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7909 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7910 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7911 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7912
7913 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7914 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7915 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7916 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7917
7918 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7919 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7920 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007921 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007922
7923 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7924 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7925 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7926
7927 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7928 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7929 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7930
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007931 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7932
7933
7934option tcp-smart-connect
7935no option tcp-smart-connect
7936 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | no | yes | yes
7939 Arguments : none
7940
7941 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7942 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7943 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7944 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7945 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7946
7947 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7948 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7949 complex.
7950
7951 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7952 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7953 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7954
7955 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7956 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7957
7958 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7959
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007960
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007961option tcpka
7962 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7964 yes | yes | yes | yes
7965 Arguments : none
7966
7967 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7968 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007969 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007970 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7971
7972 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7973 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7974 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7975 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7976
7977 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7978 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7979 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7980 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7981 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7982
7983 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7984
7985 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7986 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7987 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7988 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7989 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7990 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7991 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7992 backends.
7993
7994 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7995
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007996
7997option tcplog
7998 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008000 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008001 Arguments : none
8002
8003 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8004 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8005 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8006 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8007 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8008 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8009 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8010 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8011
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008012 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008014 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008015
8016
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008017option transparent
8018no option transparent
8019 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008021 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008022 Arguments : none
8023
8024 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8025 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8026 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8027 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8028 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8029 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8030 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8031 appropriate server.
8032
8033 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8034 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8035
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008036 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008037 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008038
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008039
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008040external-check command <command>
8041 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 yes | no | yes | yes
8044
8045 Arguments :
8046 <command> is the external command to run
8047
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008048 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8049
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008050 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008051
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008052 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8053 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8054 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8055 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8056 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8057 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008058
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008059 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8060
8061 Environment variables :
8062 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8063 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8064
8065 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8066
8067 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8068
8069 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8070 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8071 for a UNIX socket).
8072
8073 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8074
8075 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8076
8077 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8078
8079 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8080
8081 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8082
8083 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8084 socket).
8085
8086 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8087 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8088
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008089 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8090
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008091 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8092 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8093 failed.
8094
8095 Example :
8096 external-check command /bin/true
8097
8098 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8099
8100
8101external-check path <path>
8102 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8104 yes | no | yes | yes
8105
8106 Arguments :
8107 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8108
8109 The default path is "".
8110
8111 Example :
8112 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8113
8114 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8115 "external-check command"
8116
8117
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008118persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008119persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008120 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8122 yes | no | yes | yes
8123 Arguments :
8124 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008125 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8126 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008127
8128 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8129 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008130 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008131 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8132 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8133 forwarded to this server.
8134
8135 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8136 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8137 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008138 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008139 a single "listen" section.
8140
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008141 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8142 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8143 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8144
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008145 Example :
8146 listen tse-farm
8147 bind :3389
8148 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8149 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8150 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8151 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8152 persist rdp-cookie
8153 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008154 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008155 balance rdp-cookie
8156 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8157 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8158
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008159 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8160 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008161
8162
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008163rate-limit sessions <rate>
8164 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8166 yes | yes | yes | no
8167 Arguments :
8168 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8169 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8170
8171 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8172 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8173 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8174 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8175 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8176 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8177
8178 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8179 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8180 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8181 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8182
8183 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8184 listen smtp
8185 mode tcp
8186 bind :25
8187 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008188 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008189
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008190 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8191 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8192 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008193
8194 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8195
8196
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008197redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8198redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8199redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008200 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8202 no | yes | yes | yes
8203
8204 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008205 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008206
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008208 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008209 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8210 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8211 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008212
8213 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8214 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8215 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8216 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8217 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008218 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8219 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8220 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8221 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008222
8223 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8224 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8225 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8226 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8227 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8228 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008229 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008230 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008231 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8232 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8233 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008234
8235 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008236 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8237 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8238 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008239 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008240 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8241 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8242 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8243 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008244
8245 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008246 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008247
8248 - "drop-query"
8249 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8250 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8251 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8252 with a location-type redirect.
8253
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008254 - "append-slash"
8255 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8256 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8257 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8258 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8259
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008260 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8261 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8262 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8263 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8264 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8265 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8266 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8267
8268 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8269 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8270 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8271 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8272 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8273 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8274 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008275
8276 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8277 acl clear dst_port 80
8278 acl secure dst_port 8080
8279 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008280 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008281 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008282 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8283
8284 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008285 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8286 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8287 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008288 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008289
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008290 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8291 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8292 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8293
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008294 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008295 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008296
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008297 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008298 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8299 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8300 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008302 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008303
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008304
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008305retries <value>
8306 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8307 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8308 yes | no | yes | yes
8309 Arguments :
8310 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8311 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8312 default value is 3.
8313
8314 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8315 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8316 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8317
8318 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008319 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8320 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008321
8322 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8323 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8324
8325 See also : "option redispatch"
8326
8327
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008328retry-on [list of keywords]
8329 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8331 yes | no | yes | yes
8332 Arguments :
8333 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8334 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8335 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8336 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8337
8338 none never retry
8339
8340 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8341 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8342
8343 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8344 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8345 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8346 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8347 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8348 processing the request.
8349
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008350 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8351 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8352 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8353 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8354 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8355 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8356 overflow attack for example).
8357
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008358 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8359 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8360 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8361 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8362 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8363 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8364 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8365 amplify denial of service attacks.
8366
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008367 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8368 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8369 considered to be safe to retry.
8370
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008371 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8372 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8373 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8374 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8375
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008376 all-retryable-errors
8377 retry request for any error that are considered
8378 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8379 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8380 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8381
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008382 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8383 not cumulative.
8384
8385 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8386 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8387 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8388 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8389
8390 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8391 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8392 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8393 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8394 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8395 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8396 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8397 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8398 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8399 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8400 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8401 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8402
8403 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8404 should not use this directive.
8405
8406 The default is "conn-failure".
8407
8408 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8409
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008410server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008411 Declare a server in a backend
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 no | no | yes | yes
8414 Arguments :
8415 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008416 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008417 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008418
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008419 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8420 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8421 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8422 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008423 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8424 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8425 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8426 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8427 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008428 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8429 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8430 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8431 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8432 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8433 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8434 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008435 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008436 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8437 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8438 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8439 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8440 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8441 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008442 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8443 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008444 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8445 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008446
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008447 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8449 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8450 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8451 adding this value to the client's port.
8452
8453 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8454 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008455 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008456
8457 Examples :
8458 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8459 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008460 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008461 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8462 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8463 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008464
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008465 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8466 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8467 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8468 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8469 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8470
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008471 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8472 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008473
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008474server-state-file-name [<file>]
8475 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8476 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8477 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8478 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8479 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8480 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8481
8482 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8483 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8484
8485 global
8486 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8487
8488 backend bk
8489 load-server-state-from-file
8490
8491 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8492 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008493
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008494server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8495 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8496 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8498 no | no | yes | yes
8499
8500 Arguments:
8501 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8502
8503 <num | range>
8504 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8505 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8506 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8507 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8508
8509 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8510
8511 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8512
8513 <params*>
8514 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8515 keyword.
8516
8517 Examples:
8518 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8519 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8520 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8521
8522 # or
8523 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8524
8525 # would be equivalent to:
8526 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8527 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8528 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8529
8530
8531
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008532source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008533source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008534source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008535 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8537 yes | no | yes | yes
8538 Arguments :
8539 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8540 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008541
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008542 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008543 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8544 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8545 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8546 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8547 supported prefixes are :
8548 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8549 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8550 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008551 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008552 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8553 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554
8555 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8556 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008557 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8558 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8559 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008560
8561 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8562 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8563 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8564 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8565 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8566 <addr>.
8567
8568 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8569 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8570 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8571 port.
8572
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008573 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8574 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8575 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8576 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008577 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008578 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8579 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8580 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8581 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8582 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8583 HTTP header.
8584
8585 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8586 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008587 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008588 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8589 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8590 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8591 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8592 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8593 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8594 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8595
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008596 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8597 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8598 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8599 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8600 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8601 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8602
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008603 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8604 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8605 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8606 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8607
8608 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8609 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8610 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8611 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8612 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8613 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8614
8615 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8616 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8617 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8618 there are two methods :
8619
8620 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8621 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8622 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8623 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8624 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8625 of the client ranges may be used.
8626
8627 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8628 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8629 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8630 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8631 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8632 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8633 same session.
8634
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008635 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8636 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8637 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008638 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008639
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008640 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8641
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008642 Examples :
8643 backend private
8644 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8645 source 192.168.1.200
8646
8647 backend transparent_ssl1
8648 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8649 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8650
8651 backend transparent_ssl2
8652 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8653 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8654 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8655
8656 backend transparent_ssl3
8657 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8658 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8659 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8660
8661 backend transparent_smtp
8662 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8663 # with Tproxy version 4.
8664 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8665
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008666 backend transparent_http
8667 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8668 # proxy.
8669 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008671 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008672 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8673
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008674
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008675stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8676 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008678 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008679
8680 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8681 matched.
8682
8683 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8684 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8685
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008686 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8687 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008688 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008689
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008690 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8691 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8692 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8693 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008694
8695 Example :
8696 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8697 backend stats_localhost
8698 stats enable
8699 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8700
8701 Example :
8702 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8703 backend stats_auth
8704 stats enable
8705 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8706 stats admin if TRUE
8707
8708 Example :
8709 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8710 userlist stats-auth
8711 group admin users admin
8712 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8713 group readonly users haproxy
8714 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8715
8716 backend stats_auth
8717 stats enable
8718 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8719 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8720 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8721 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8722
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008723 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8724 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8725 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008726
8727
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008728stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8729 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008731 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008732 Arguments :
8733 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8734
8735 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8736
8737 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8738 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8739 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8740 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8741 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8742 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8743
8744 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8745 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8746 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008747 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008748
8749 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8750 report using "stats scope".
8751
8752 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8753 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8754 unobvious parameters.
8755
8756 Example :
8757 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8758 backend public_www
8759 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8760 stats enable
8761 stats hide-version
8762 stats scope .
8763 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008764 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008765 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8766 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8767
8768 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8769 backend private_monitoring
8770 stats enable
8771 stats uri /admin?stats
8772 stats refresh 5s
8773
8774 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8775
8776
8777stats enable
8778 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008780 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008781 Arguments : none
8782
8783 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8784 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8785 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8786 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8787 - stats auth : no authentication
8788 - stats scope : no restriction
8789
8790 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8791 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8792 unobvious parameters.
8793
8794 Example :
8795 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8796 backend public_www
8797 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8798 stats enable
8799 stats hide-version
8800 stats scope .
8801 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008802 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008803 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8804 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8805
8806 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8807 backend private_monitoring
8808 stats enable
8809 stats uri /admin?stats
8810 stats refresh 5s
8811
8812 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8813
8814
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008815stats hide-version
8816 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008818 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008819 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008820
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008821 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8822 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8823 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8824 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8825 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8826 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008828 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8829 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8830 unobvious parameters.
8831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008832 Example :
8833 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8834 backend public_www
8835 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008836 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008837 stats hide-version
8838 stats scope .
8839 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008841 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8842 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008843
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008844 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8845 backend private_monitoring
8846 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008847 stats uri /admin?stats
8848 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008849
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008850 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008851
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008852
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008853stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8854 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8855 Access control for statistics
8856
8857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8858 no | no | yes | yes
8859
8860 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8861 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8862 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8863 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8864 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8865 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8866
8867 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8868 instance.
8869
8870 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8871 about ACL usage.
8872
8873
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008874stats realm <realm>
8875 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008878 Arguments :
8879 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8880 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8881 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8882
8883 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8884 using a backslash ('\').
8885
8886 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8887 only related to authentication.
8888
8889 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8890 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8891 unobvious parameters.
8892
8893 Example :
8894 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8895 backend public_www
8896 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8897 stats enable
8898 stats hide-version
8899 stats scope .
8900 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008901 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008902 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8903 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8904
8905 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8906 backend private_monitoring
8907 stats enable
8908 stats uri /admin?stats
8909 stats refresh 5s
8910
8911 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8912
8913
8914stats refresh <delay>
8915 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008917 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008918 Arguments :
8919 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8920 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8921 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8922 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8923 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8924 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8925
8926 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8927 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8928 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8929 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8930
8931 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8932 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8933 unobvious parameters.
8934
8935 Example :
8936 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8937 backend public_www
8938 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8939 stats enable
8940 stats hide-version
8941 stats scope .
8942 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008943 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008944 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8945 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8946
8947 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8948 backend private_monitoring
8949 stats enable
8950 stats uri /admin?stats
8951 stats refresh 5s
8952
8953 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8954
8955
8956stats scope { <name> | "." }
8957 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008960 Arguments :
8961 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8962 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8963 section in which the statement appears.
8964
8965 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8966 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8967 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8968 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8969 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8970 exists.
8971
8972 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8973 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8974 unobvious parameters.
8975
8976 Example :
8977 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8978 backend public_www
8979 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8980 stats enable
8981 stats hide-version
8982 stats scope .
8983 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008984 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008985 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8986 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8987
8988 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8989 backend private_monitoring
8990 stats enable
8991 stats uri /admin?stats
8992 stats refresh 5s
8993
8994 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8995
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008996
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008997stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008998 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009000 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009001
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009002 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009003 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9004
9005 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9006 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9007
9008 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9009 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009010 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009011
9012 Example :
9013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9014 backend private_monitoring
9015 stats enable
9016 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9017 stats uri /admin?stats
9018 stats refresh 5s
9019
9020 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9021 global section.
9022
9023
9024stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009025 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9027 yes | yes | yes | yes
9028 Arguments : none
9029
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009030 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009031 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9032 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9033 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9034 - IP (socket, server)
9035 - cookie (backend, server)
9036
9037 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9038 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009039 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009040
9041 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9042
9043
9044stats show-node [ <name> ]
9045 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009047 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009048 Arguments:
9049 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9050 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9051
9052 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9053 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009054 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009055
9056 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9057 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9058 unobvious parameters.
9059
9060 Example:
9061 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9062 backend private_monitoring
9063 stats enable
9064 stats show-node Europe-1
9065 stats uri /admin?stats
9066 stats refresh 5s
9067
9068 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9069 section.
9070
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009071
9072stats uri <prefix>
9073 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009075 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009076 Arguments :
9077 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9078 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9079 query string.
9080
9081 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9082 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9083 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9084 possible to reach it in the application.
9085
9086 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009087 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009088 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9089 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9090 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9091 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9092
9093 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9094 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9095 an address or a port to statistics only.
9096
9097 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9098 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9099 unobvious parameters.
9100
9101 Example :
9102 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9103 backend public_www
9104 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9105 stats enable
9106 stats hide-version
9107 stats scope .
9108 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009109 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009110 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9111 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9112
9113 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9114 backend private_monitoring
9115 stats enable
9116 stats uri /admin?stats
9117 stats refresh 5s
9118
9119 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9120
9121
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009122stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9123 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009125 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009126
9127 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009128 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009129 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009130 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009131 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9132
9133 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9134 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9135 the "stick-table" statement.
9136
9137 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9138 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9139 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9140 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9141 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9142
9143 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9144 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9145 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9146 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9147 transformation rules.
9148
9149 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9150 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9151 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9152 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9153 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9154 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9155 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9156
9157 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9158 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9159 ACL based conditions.
9160
9161 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9162 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9163 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9164 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9165
9166 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9167 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9168 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9169 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9170
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009171 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9172 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009174
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009175 Example :
9176 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9177 # last 30 minutes
9178 backend pop
9179 mode tcp
9180 balance roundrobin
9181 stick store-request src
9182 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9183 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9184 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9185
9186 backend smtp
9187 mode tcp
9188 balance roundrobin
9189 stick match src table pop
9190 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9191 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9192
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009193 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009194 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009195
9196
9197stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9198 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9200 no | no | yes | yes
9201
9202 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9203 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9204 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9205 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9206
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009207 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9208 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009209 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009210
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009211 Examples :
9212 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009213 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009214
9215 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9216 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9217 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9218
9219
9220 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9221 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9222 backend http
9223 mode http
9224 balance roundrobin
9225 stick on src table https
9226 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9227 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9228 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9229
9230 backend https
9231 mode tcp
9232 balance roundrobin
9233 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9234 stick on src
9235 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9236 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9237
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009238 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009239
9240
9241stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9242 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9244 no | no | yes | yes
9245
9246 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009247 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009248 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009249 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009250 server is selected.
9251
9252 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9253 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9254 the "stick-table" statement.
9255
9256 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9257 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9258 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9259 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9260 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9261 address.
9262
9263 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9264 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9265 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9266 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9267 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9268 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9269 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9270 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9271 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9272 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9273
9274 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9275 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9276 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9277 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9278 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9279 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9280 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9281
9282 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9283 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9284 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9285 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9286
9287 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9288 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9289 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9290 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9291 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9292 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009293 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9294 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9295 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9296 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9297 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9298 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009299
9300 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9301 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9302 the request.
9303
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009304 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9305 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009306 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009307
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009308 Example :
9309 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9310 # last 30 minutes
9311 backend pop
9312 mode tcp
9313 balance roundrobin
9314 stick store-request src
9315 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9316 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9317 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9318
9319 backend smtp
9320 mode tcp
9321 balance roundrobin
9322 stick match src table pop
9323 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9324 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9325
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009326 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009327 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009328
9329
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009330stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009331 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9332 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009333 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009335 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009336
9337 Arguments :
9338 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9339 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9340 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9341 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9342
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009343 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9344 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9345 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9346 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9347
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009348 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9349 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9350 instance.
9351
9352 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9353 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9354 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9355 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9356 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9357 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009358 to 32 characters.
9359
9360 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9361 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9362 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009363 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009364 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9365 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009366
9367 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009368 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9369 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009370 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9371 increase.
9372
9373 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009374 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9375 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9376 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009377
9378 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9379 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9380 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9381 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009382 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009383 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9384 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9385 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9386 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9387 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9388 parameter (see below).
9389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009390 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9391 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9392 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9393 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9394 soft restart.
9395
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009396 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9397 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009398
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009399 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9400 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9401 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9402 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009403 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009404 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009405 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9406 if not expiration delay is specified.
9407
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009408 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9409 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9410 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9411 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009412 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9413 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9414 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9415 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9416 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9417 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9418 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9419 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9420 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9421 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9422 types and their arguments.
9423
9424 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9425 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9426 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9427 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9428
9429 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9430 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9431 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009432 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009433
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009434 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9435 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9436 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009437 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009438 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009439 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009440
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009441 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9442 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9443 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9444 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9445
9446 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9447 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9448 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9449 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9450 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9451 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9452
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009453 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9454 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9455 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9456 they were received.
9457
9458 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9459 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9460 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9461 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9462 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9463
9464 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9465 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9466 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9467 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9468 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9469
9470 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9471 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9472 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9473
9474 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9477 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9478 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9479
9480 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9481 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9482 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9483 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9484 the client side.
9485
9486 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9487 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9488 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9489 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9490 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9491 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9492 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9493
9494 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9495 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9496 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9497 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9498 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9499 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009500 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009501
9502 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9503 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9504 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9505 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9506 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9507 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9508
9509 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009510 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009511 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9512 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9513
9514 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9515 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9516 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9517 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9518 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9519 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9520 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9521 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9522 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9523 recommended for better fairness.
9524
9525 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009526 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009527 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9528 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9529
9530 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9531 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9532 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9533 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9534 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9535 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9536 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9537 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9538 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9539 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009540
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009541 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9542 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009543 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9544 reference it.
9545
9546 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9547 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009548 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9549 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9550 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009551
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009552 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9553 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9554 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9555 something that can be ignored.
9556
9557 Example:
9558 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9559 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9560 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9561 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9562
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009563 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009564 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009565
9566
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009567stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009568 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9570 no | no | yes | yes
9571
9572 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009573 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009574 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009575 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009576 server is selected.
9577
9578 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9579 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9580 the "stick-table" statement.
9581
9582 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9583 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9584 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9585 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9586
9587 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9588 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9589 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9590 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9591 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9592 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009593 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009594 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9595 rules.
9596
9597 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9598 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9599 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9600 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9601 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9602 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9603 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9604
9605 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9606 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9607 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9608 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9609
9610 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9611 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9612 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9613 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9614 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9615 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009616 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9617 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9618 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9619 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9620 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9621 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9622 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9623 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9624 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009625
9626 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9627
9628 Example :
9629 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9630 backend https
9631 mode tcp
9632 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009633 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009634 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009635
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009636 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9637 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9638
9639 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9640 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9641 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9642
9643 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9644 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009645
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009646 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9647 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9648 # at offset 44.
9649
9650 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9651 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9652
9653 # Learn on response if server hello.
9654 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009655
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009656 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9657 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9658
9659 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9660 extraction.
9661
9662
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009663tcp-check connect [params*]
9664 Opens a new connection
9665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9666 no | no | yes | yes
9667
9668 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9669 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9670 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9671
9672 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9673 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9674 of the sequence.
9675
9676 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9677 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9678 do.
9679
9680 Parameters :
9681 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9682 use the TCP connection.
9683
9684 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9685 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9686 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9687
9688 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9689
9690 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9691
9692 Examples:
9693 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9694 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9695 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9696 option tcp-check
9697 tcp-check connect
9698 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9699 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9700 tcp-check send \r\n
9701 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9702 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9703 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9704 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9705 tcp-check send \r\n
9706 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9707 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9708
9709 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9710 option tcp-check
9711 tcp-check connect port 110
9712 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9713 tcp-check connect port 143
9714 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9715 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9716
9717 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9718
9719
9720tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009721 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9723 no | no | yes | yes
9724
9725 Arguments :
9726 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9727 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9728 binary.
9729 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9730 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9731 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9732
9733 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9734 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9735 with the usual backslash ('\').
9736 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009737 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009738 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9739 used upper or lower case.
9740
9741
9742 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9743
9744 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9745 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9746 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9747 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9748 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9749 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9750 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9751 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9752
9753 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9754 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9755 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9756 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9757 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9758 expression.
9759
9760 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9761 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9762 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9763 this exact hexadecimal string.
9764 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9765
9766 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9767 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9768 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9769 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9770 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9771 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9772 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9773 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9774 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9775 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9776 the null character.
9777
9778 Examples :
9779 # perform a POP check
9780 option tcp-check
9781 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9782
9783 # perform an IMAP check
9784 option tcp-check
9785 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9786
9787 # look for the redis master server
9788 option tcp-check
9789 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009790 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009791 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9792 tcp-check expect string role:master
9793 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9794 tcp-check expect string +OK
9795
9796
9797 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9798 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9799
9800
9801tcp-check send <data>
9802 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9804 no | no | yes | yes
9805
9806 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9807 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9808
9809 Examples :
9810 # look for the redis master server
9811 option tcp-check
9812 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9813 tcp-check expect string role:master
9814
9815 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9816 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9817
9818
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009819tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9820 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009821 tcp health check
9822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9823 no | no | yes | yes
9824
9825 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9826 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009827 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009828 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9829 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9830 hexadecimal string.
9831 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9832
9833 Examples :
9834 # redis check in binary
9835 option tcp-check
9836 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9837 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9838
9839
9840 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9841 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9842
9843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009844tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9845 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9847 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009848 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009849 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9850 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009851
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009852 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009853
9854 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9855 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009856 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9857 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9858 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9859 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9860 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9861 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009862
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009863 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9864 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9865 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9866 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009867
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009868 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009869 - accept :
9870 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9871 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9872 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009874 - reject :
9875 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9876 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9877 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9878 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9879 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9880 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9881 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9882 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9883 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9884 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9885 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009886 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009887
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009888 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9889 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9890 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9891 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9892 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9893 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9894 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9895 hosts.
9896
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009897 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9898 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9899 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9900 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9901 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9902 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9903 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9904 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9905
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009906 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9907 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9908 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9909 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9910 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9911 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9912 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9913 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9914 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009915 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9916 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009917
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009918 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009919 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009920 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9921 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9922 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009923 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009924 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9925 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9926 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9927 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9928 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9929 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9930 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9931 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009933 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009934 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009935 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009936 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009937 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9938 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9939 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009940
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009941 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9942 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9943 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9944 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009946 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9947 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9948 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9949 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9950 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009951 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9952 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9953 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9954 layer7 information is extracted.
9955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009956 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9957 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9958 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9959 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9960 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009961
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009962 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9963 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9964 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9965 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9966
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009967 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9968 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9969 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9970 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9971
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009972 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9973 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9974 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9975 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9976 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009977
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009978 - set-src <expr> :
9979 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9980 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9981 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009982 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009984 Arguments:
9985 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9986 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009987
9988 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009989 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9990
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009991 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9992 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009993
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009994 - set-src-port <expr> :
9995 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9996 expression.
9997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009998 Arguments:
9999 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10000 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010001
10002 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010003 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10004
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010005 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10006 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10007 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010008
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010009 - set-dst <expr> :
10010 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10011 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10012 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10013 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10014 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10015
10016 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10017 followed by some converters.
10018
10019 Example:
10020
10021 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10022 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10023
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010024 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10025 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10026
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010027 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10028 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10029 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10030 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10031
10032
10033 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10034 followed by some converters.
10035
10036 Example:
10037
10038 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10039
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010040 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10041 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10042 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10043
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010044 - "silent-drop" :
10045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010046 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010047 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10048 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10049 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10050 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10051 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010052 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10053 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010054 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10055 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010056 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010057 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10058 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10059 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10060 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010062 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10063 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10064 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010066 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10067 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10068 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010070 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010071 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010072 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010074 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10075 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10076 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010078 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010079 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10080 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010081
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010082 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10083
10084 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10085
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010086 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10087
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010088 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010089
10090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010091tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10092 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010094 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010095 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010096 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10097 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010099 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010101 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010102 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10103 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10104 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10105 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010107 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10108 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10109 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10110 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010111 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10112 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10113 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10114 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10115 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10116 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010117 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010118 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010120 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10121 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10122 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10123 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010124
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010125 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010126 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010127 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010128 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10129 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010130 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010131 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010132 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010133 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010134 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010135 - set-dst <expr>
10136 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010137 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010138 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010139 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010140 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010141 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010143 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10144 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010145 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10146 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010147
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010148 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10149 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10150 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10151 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10152 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10153 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010155 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010156 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10157 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010159 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010160 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10161 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10162 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10163 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010164 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10165 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10166 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010167
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010168 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010169 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10170 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10171 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010172
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010173 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10174 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10175
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010176 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010177 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10178 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010179
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010180 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10181 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010182 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010183 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10184 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010185 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010187 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010188 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10189 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010190 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010191 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10192 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010193
10194 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10195 followed by some converters.
10196
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010197 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10198 <var-name>.
10199
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010200 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10201 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10202 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10203 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10204 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10205
10206 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10207 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10208 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10209 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10210 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10211 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10212 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10213 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10214 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10215 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10216 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10217
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010218 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10219 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10220 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10221 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10222 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10223
10224 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10225
10226 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10227
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010228 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10229 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10230 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10231 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10232 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10233 evaluated.
10234
10235 Example:
10236 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10237
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010238 Example:
10239
10240 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010241 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010242
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010243 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010244 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10245 # and reject everything else.
10246 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10247 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010248 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010249 tcp-request content reject
10250
10251 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010252 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10253 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10254 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010255 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010256
10257 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10258 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10259 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010260 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010261 tcp-request content reject
10262
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010263 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010264 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010265 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010266 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010267 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10268 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010269
10270 Example:
10271 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10272 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010273 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010275 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010276 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010277
10278 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010279 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010280 # protecting all our sites
10281 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010282 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10283 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010284 ...
10285 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10286
10287 backend http_dynamic
10288 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010289 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010290 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010291 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010292 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010293 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010294 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010296 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010297
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010298 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10299 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010300
10301
10302tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10303 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010305 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010306 Arguments :
10307 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10308 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10309 as explained at the top of this document.
10310
10311 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10312 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10313 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10314 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10315 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10316
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010317 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10318 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10319 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10320 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10321
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010322 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10323 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010324 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010325 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010326 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10327 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10328 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10329 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010330
10331 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10332 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10333 it pass through unaffected.
10334
10335 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10336 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10337 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010338 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010339 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10340 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010341 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10342 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10343 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010344
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010345 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010346 "timeout client".
10347
10348
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010349tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10350 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10352 no | no | yes | yes
10353 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010354 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10355 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010356
10357 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10358
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010359 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010360 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10361 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010362 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10363 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010364
10365 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10366
10367 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10368 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10369 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10370 inserted.
10371
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010372 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010373 - accept :
10374 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10375 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10376 the rules evaluation.
10377
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010378 - close :
10379 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10380 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10381 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10382 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10383 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10384 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010385 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010386 protocols.
10387
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010388 - reject :
10389 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10390 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010391 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010392
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010393 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10394 Sets a variable.
10395
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010396 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10397 Unsets a variable.
10398
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010399 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10400 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10401 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10402 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10403
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010404 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10405 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10406 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10407 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10408
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010409 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10410 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10411 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10412 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10413 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010414
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010415 - "silent-drop" :
10416 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010417 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010418 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10419 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10420 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10421 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10422 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010423 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10424 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010425 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10426 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010427 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010428 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10429 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10430 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10431 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10432
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010433 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10434 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10435
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010436 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10437 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10438 for changing the default action to a reject.
10439
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010440 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10441 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10442 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10443 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010444 period.
10445
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010446 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10447 declared inline.
10448
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010449 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10450 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010451 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010452 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10453 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010454 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010455 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010456 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010457 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10458 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010459 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010460 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10461 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010462
10463 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10464 followed by some converters.
10465
10466 Example:
10467
10468 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10469
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010470 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10471 <var-name>.
10472
10473 Example:
10474
10475 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10476
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010477 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10478 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10479 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10480 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10481 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10482
10483 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10484
10485 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10486
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10488
10489 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10490
10491
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010492tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10493 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 no | yes | yes | no
10496 Arguments :
10497 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10498 below.
10499
10500 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010503 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10504 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10505 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10506 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10507 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10508 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10509 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010510 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010511 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10512 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10513 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10514 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10515 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10516 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10517 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10518 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10519 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10520 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10521 instead.
10522
10523 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10524 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10525 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10526 rules which may be inserted.
10527
10528 Several types of actions are supported :
10529 - accept : the request is accepted
10530 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10531 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10532 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010533 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010534 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010535 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010536 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010537 - silent-drop
10538
10539 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10540 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10541 sections for a complete description.
10542
10543 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10544 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10545 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10546
10547 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10548 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10549 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10550 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10551 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10552
10553 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10554 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10555
10556 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10557 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10558 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10559
10560 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10561 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10562 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10563
10564 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10565 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10566 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10567
10568 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10569 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10570 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10571
10572 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10573
10574 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10575
10576
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010577tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10578 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10580 no | no | yes | yes
10581 Arguments :
10582 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10583 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10584 as explained at the top of this document.
10585
10586 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10587
10588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010589timeout check <timeout>
10590 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10591 established.
10592
10593 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10594 yes | no | yes | yes
10595 Arguments:
10596 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10597 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10598 as explained at the top of this document.
10599
10600 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10601 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010602 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010603 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010604 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10605 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10606 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010607
10608 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10609 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10610
10611 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10612 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010613 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010614
10615 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10616 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10617 forget about it.
10618
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010619 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10620 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010621
10622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010623timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010624 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10626 yes | yes | yes | no
10627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010628 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10630 as explained at the top of this document.
10631
10632 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10633 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10634 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010635 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10636 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10637 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10638 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010639 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10640 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10641 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010642 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010643 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010644 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10645 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010646 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10647 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010648
10649 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10650 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10651 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10652 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010653 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010654 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10655
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010656 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010657
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010658 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010660
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010661timeout client-fin <timeout>
10662 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10664 yes | yes | yes | no
10665 Arguments :
10666 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10667 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10668 as explained at the top of this document.
10669
10670 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10671 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10672 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10673 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10674 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10675 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10676 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010677 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10678 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10679 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010680
10681 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10682 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10683 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10684
10685 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10686
10687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010688timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010689 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10691 yes | no | yes | yes
10692 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010693 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010694 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10695 as explained at the top of this document.
10696
10697 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010698 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010699 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010700 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010701 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10702 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010703
10704 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10705 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10706 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10707 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010708 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010709 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10710
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010711 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010713
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010714timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10715 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10717 yes | yes | yes | yes
10718 Arguments :
10719 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10720 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10721 as explained at the top of this document.
10722
10723 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10724 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10725 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10726 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10727 once the request has started to present itself.
10728
10729 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10730 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10731 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10732 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10733 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10734
10735 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10736 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10737 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10738 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10739
10740 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10741 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010742 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010743 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10744 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010745 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010746
10747 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10748 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10749 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10750 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10751
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010752 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10753 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010754 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10755
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010756 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10757
10758
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010759timeout http-request <timeout>
10760 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010762 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010763 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010764 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10766 as explained at the top of this document.
10767
10768 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10769 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10770 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10771 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10772 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10773 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10774 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010775 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10776 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10777 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10778 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010779 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010780 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10781 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010782
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010783 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10784 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10785 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10786 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10787 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010788 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010789
10790 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10791 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010793 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10794 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10795
10796 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010797 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10798 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10799 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010800
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010801 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010802 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010803
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010804
10805timeout queue <timeout>
10806 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10808 yes | no | yes | yes
10809 Arguments :
10810 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10812 as explained at the top of this document.
10813
10814 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10815 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10816 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10817 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10818 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10819
10820 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10821 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10822 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10823 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10824
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010825 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010826
10827
10828timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010829 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10831 yes | no | yes | yes
10832 Arguments :
10833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10835 as explained at the top of this document.
10836
10837 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10838 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10839 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10840 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10841 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10842 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10843 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10844
10845 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10846 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10847 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10848 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10849 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010850 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010851 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010852 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10853 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010854 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10855 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010856
10857 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10858 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10859 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10860 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010861 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010862 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10863
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010864 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010865
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010866
10867timeout server-fin <timeout>
10868 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10870 yes | no | yes | yes
10871 Arguments :
10872 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10873 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10874 as explained at the top of this document.
10875
10876 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10877 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10878 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10879 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10880 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10881 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10882 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10883 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10884 situations, it should not be needed.
10885
10886 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10887 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10888 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10889
10890 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10891
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010892
10893timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010894 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10896 yes | yes | yes | yes
10897 Arguments :
10898 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10900 as explained at the top of this document.
10901
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010902 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10903 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10904 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010905
10906 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10907 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10908 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10909 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010910 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010911
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010912 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010913
10914
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010915timeout tunnel <timeout>
10916 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10918 yes | no | yes | yes
10919 Arguments :
10920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10922 as explained at the top of this document.
10923
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010924 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010925 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10926 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10927 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010928 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10929 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010930 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10931 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10932 specified.
10933
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010934 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10935 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10936 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10937 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10938 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10939 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10940 state.
10941
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010942 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10943 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10944 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10945 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010947
10948 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10949 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10950 forget about it.
10951
10952 Example :
10953 defaults http
10954 option http-server-close
10955 timeout connect 5s
10956 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010957 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010958 timeout server 30s
10959 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10960
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010961 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010962
10963
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010964transparent (deprecated)
10965 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010968 Arguments : none
10969
10970 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10971 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10972 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10973 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10974 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10975 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10976 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10977 appropriate server.
10978
10979 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10980
10981 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10982 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10983
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010984 See also: "option transparent"
10985
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010986unique-id-format <string>
10987 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10989 yes | yes | yes | no
10990 Arguments :
10991 <string> is a log-format string.
10992
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010993 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10994 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10995 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10996 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010997
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010998 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10999 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11000 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11001 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11002 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11003 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11004 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11005 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011006
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011007 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11008 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011009
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011010 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011011
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011012 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011013
11014 will generate:
11015
11016 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11017
11018 See also: "unique-id-header"
11019
11020unique-id-header <name>
11021 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11023 yes | yes | yes | no
11024 Arguments :
11025 <name> is the name of the header.
11026
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011027 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11028 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011029
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011030 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011031
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011032 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011033 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11034
11035 will generate:
11036
11037 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11038
11039 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011040
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011041use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011042 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11044 no | yes | yes | no
11045 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011046 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11047 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011048
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011049 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11050 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011051
11052 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11053 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11054 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011055 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011056 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011057 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11058 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011059
11060 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11061 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11062 assign the backend.
11063
11064 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11065 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11066 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11067 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11068 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11069 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11070
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011071 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011072 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011073 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11074 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11075 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11076
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011077 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11078 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11079 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11080 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11081 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11082 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11083 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11084 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11085 cannot be forced from the request.
11086
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011087 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011088 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11089 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11090
11091 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11092 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011093
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011094use-fcgi-app <name>
11095 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11097 no | no | yes | yes
11098 Arguments :
11099 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11100
11101 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011102
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011103use-server <server> if <condition>
11104use-server <server> unless <condition>
11105 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11107 no | no | yes | yes
11108 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011109 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011110
11111 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11112
11113 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11114 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11115 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11116
11117 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11118 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11119 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11120 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11121 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11122 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11123 matches will assign the server.
11124
11125 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11126 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11127 with the next rules until one matches.
11128
11129 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11130 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11131 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11132 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11133
11134 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11135 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11136 stripped.
11137
11138 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11139 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11140 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11141 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11142
11143 Example :
11144 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11145 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11146 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11147 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11148 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11149 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011150 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011151 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11152 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11153
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011154 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011155
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011156
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100111575. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011158--------------------------
11159
11160The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11161depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11162settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11163written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11164described in this section.
11165
11166
111675.1. Bind options
11168-----------------
11169
11170The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11171as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11172no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11173parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11174while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11175provided immediately after the setting name.
11176
11177The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11178
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011179accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11180 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11181 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11182 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11183 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11184 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11185 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11186 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11187 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11188 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011189 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11190 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11191 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011192
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011193accept-proxy
11194 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011195 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11196 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011197 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11198 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11199 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11200 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011201 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011202 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11203 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011204 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11205 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011206
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011207allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011208 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011209 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011210 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011211 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11212 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011213
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011214alpn <protocols>
11215 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11216 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11217 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011218 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011219 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011220 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11221 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11222 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11223 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11224 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11225 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11226 preference, like below :
11227
11228 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011230backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011231 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011232 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11233
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011234curves <curves>
11235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11236 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11237 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11238 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11239 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11240 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11241
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011242ecdhe <named curve>
11243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011244 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11245 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011246
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011247ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11249 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11250 client's certificate.
11251
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011252ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11254 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11255 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11256 error is ignored.
11257
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011258ca-sign-file <cafile>
11259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11260 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11261 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11262 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11263 'generate-certificates' for details.
11264
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011265ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11267 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11268 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11269 'generate-certificates' for details.
11270
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011271ciphers <ciphers>
11272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11273 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011274 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011275 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011276 information and recommendations see e.g.
11277 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11278 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11279 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11280
11281ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11283 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11284 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11285 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011286 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11287 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011288
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011289crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11291 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11292 to verify client's certificate.
11293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011294crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11296 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11297 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11298 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11299 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11300 file.
11301
11302 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11303 are loaded.
11304
11305 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011306 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011307 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11308 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11309 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11310 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011311 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11312 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011313 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011314
11315 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11316 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11317 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11318 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011319 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11320 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011321
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011322 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011323
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011324 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011325 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011326 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11327 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011328 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11329 clients).
11330
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011331 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11332 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11333 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11334 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11335 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11336 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11337 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11338 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11339 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11340 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11341 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11342 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11343 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11344
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011345 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11346 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11347 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11348 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11349 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11350
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011351 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11352 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11353 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11354 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011355
11356 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11357 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11358 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11359 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11360 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11361 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11362 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11363 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11364 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11365
11366 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11367
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011368 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011369 a cert bundle.
11370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011372 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11373 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11374 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11375 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11376 provide multi-cert support.
11377
11378 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11379
11380 Filename | CN | SAN
11381 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11382 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011383 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011384 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11385 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11386
11387 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11388 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11389 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11390 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011391 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11392 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11393 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011394
11395 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11396 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11397
11398 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11399 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11400 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11401
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011402crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011404 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011405 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011406 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011407
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011408crt-list <file>
11409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011410 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11411 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011412
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011413 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11414
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011415 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11416 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011417 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011418 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011419
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011420 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11421 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11422 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11423 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11424 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11425 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11426 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11427 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011428
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011429 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011430 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011431 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11432 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11433 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011434
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011435 crt-list file example:
11436 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011437 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011438 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011439 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011440
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011441defer-accept
11442 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11443 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11444 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011445 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011446 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11447 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11448 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11449 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11450 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11451 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11452 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11453
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011454expose-fd listeners
11455 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11456 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011457 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11458 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011459 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011460
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011461force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011462 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011463 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011464 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011465 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011466
11467force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011468 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011469 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011470 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011471
11472force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011473 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011474 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011475 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011476
11477force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011478 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011479 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011480 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011481
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011482force-tlsv13
11483 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11484 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011485 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011486
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011487generate-certificates
11488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11489 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11490 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11491 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11492 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11493 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11494 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11495 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11496 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11497 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11498 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11499
11500 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11501 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011502 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011503 certificate is used many times.
11504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011505gid <gid>
11506 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11507 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11508 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11509 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11510 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11511
11512group <group>
11513 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11514 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11515 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11516 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11517 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11518
11519id <id>
11520 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11521 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11522 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11523 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11524
11525interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011526 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11527 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11528 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11529 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11530 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11531 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011532 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11533 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11534 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11535 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11536 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11537 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011538
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011539level <level>
11540 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11541 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11542 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011544 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11545 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11546 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011547 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011548 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011550 all counters).
11551
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011552severity-output <format>
11553 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11554 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11555 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11556 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11557 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11558 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11559 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11560 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11561 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11562 rfc5424 convention.
11563
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011564maxconn <maxconn>
11565 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11566 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11567 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11568 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11569 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11570 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11571 eat all memory.
11572
11573mode <mode>
11574 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11575 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11576 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11577 UNIX sockets.
11578
11579mss <maxseg>
11580 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11581 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11582 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11583 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11584 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11585 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11586 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11587 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11588 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11589 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11590 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11591
11592name <name>
11593 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11594 page.
11595
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011596namespace <name>
11597 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11598 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11599 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11600 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11601
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011602nice <nice>
11603 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11604 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11605 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11606 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11607 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11608 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11609 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11610 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11611 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11612 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11613 one for an RDP socket.
11614
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011615no-ca-names
11616 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11617 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11618
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011619no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011620 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011621 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011622 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011623 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011624 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11625 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011626
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011627no-tls-tickets
11628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11629 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11630 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011631 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11632 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011633
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011634no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011636 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011637 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011638 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011639 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11640 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011641
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011642no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011644 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011645 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011646 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011647 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11648 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011649
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011650no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011652 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011653 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011654 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011655 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11656 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011657
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011658no-tlsv13
11659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11660 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11661 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11662 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011663 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11664 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011665
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011666npn <protocols>
11667 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11668 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11669 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011670 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011671 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011672 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11673 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11674 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11675 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11676 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011677
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011678prefer-client-ciphers
11679 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11680 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11681 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011682 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11683 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11684 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011685
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011686process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011687 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011688 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011689 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011690 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11691 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11692 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11693 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011694 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011695 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11696 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11697 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11698 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11699 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011700
11701 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11702
11703 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11704 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11705 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11706 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11707 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11708 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11709 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11710 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011711
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011712proto <name>
11713 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11714 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11715 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11716 in haproxy -vv.
11717 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11718 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011719 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011720 h2" on the bind line.
11721
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011722ssl
11723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011724 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011725 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11726 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011727 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11728 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011729
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011730ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11731 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11732 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11733 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11734
11735ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11736 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11737 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11738 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11739
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011740strict-sni
11741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11742 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11743 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11744 See the "crt" option for more information.
11745
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011746tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011747 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011748 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11749 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011750 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011751 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11752 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11753 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11754 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11755 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11756 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11757 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11758
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011759tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011760 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011761 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11762 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11763 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11764 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11765 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11766 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11767 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011768 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11769 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11770 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011771
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011772tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11773 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011774 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11775 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11776 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11777 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11778 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11779 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11780 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11781 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11782 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11783 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011784 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11785 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011787transparent
11788 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11789 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11790 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11791 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11792 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11793 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11794 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11795 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11796 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11797 so check for support with your vendor.
11798
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011799v4v6
11800 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11801 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11802 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11803 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011804 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011805
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011806v6only
11807 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11808 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11809 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011810 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11811 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011812
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011813uid <uid>
11814 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11815 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11816 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11817 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11818 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11819
11820user <user>
11821 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11822 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11823 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11824 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11825 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11826
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011827verify [none|optional|required]
11828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11829 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11830 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11831 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11832 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011833 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11834 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11835 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11836 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011837
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200118385.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011839------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011841The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11842which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11843arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11844settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11845after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11846Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11847address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011849 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011850 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011851
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011852Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11853keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011855The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011856
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011857addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011858 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011859 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11860 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11861 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11862 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11863 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011864
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011865agent-check
11866 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011867 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011868 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11869 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11870 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011871
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011872 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011873 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011874 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11875 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11876 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011877
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011878 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11879 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11880 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11881 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11882 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011883
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011884 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011885 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011886
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011887 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11888 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11889 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011890
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011891 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11892 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11893 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011894
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011895 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11896 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11897 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11898 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11899 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011900 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011901 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011902
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011903 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11904 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011905
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011906 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11907 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11908 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11909 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11910 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11911 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11912 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11913 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11914 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011915
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011916 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11917 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011918 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11919 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11920 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011921 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011922
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011923 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011924 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011925
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011926agent-send <string>
11927 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11928 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11929 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11930 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11931 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11932
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011933agent-inter <delay>
11934 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11935 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11936
11937 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11938 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11939 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11940 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11941 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11942 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11943 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11944 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11945 of backends use the same servers.
11946
11947 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11948
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011949agent-addr <addr>
11950 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11951
11952 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11953 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11954 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11955 hostname, it will be resolved.
11956
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011957agent-port <port>
11958 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11959
11960 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11961
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011962allow-0rtt
11963 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011964 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11965 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011966
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011967alpn <protocols>
11968 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11969 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11970 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011971 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011972 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11973 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11974 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11975 now obsolete NPN extension.
11976 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11977 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11978
11979 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011981backup
11982 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11983 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11984 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11985 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011986 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11987 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011988
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011989ca-file <cafile>
11990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11991 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11992 server's certificate.
11993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011994check
11995 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011996 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11997 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11998 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11999 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12000 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12001 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12002 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012003 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12004 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012005 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12006 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012007
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012008check-send-proxy
12009 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12010 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12011 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12012 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12013 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12014 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12015 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12016
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012017check-alpn <protocols>
12018 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12019 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12020 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12021
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012022check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012023 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012024 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12025 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012026
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012027check-ssl
12028 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12029 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12030 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12031 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012032 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012033 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12034 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012035 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012036 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12037 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012038
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012039check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012040 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012041 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12042 for normal traffic.
12043
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012044ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12046 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12047 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012048 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12049 information and recommendations see e.g.
12050 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12051 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12052 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012053
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012054ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12056 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12057 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12058 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012059 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12060 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12061 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012063cookie <value>
12064 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12065 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12066 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12067 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12068 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12069 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12070 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12071
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012072crl-file <crlfile>
12073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12074 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12075 to verify server's certificate.
12076
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012077crt <cert>
12078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12079 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12080 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12081 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12082 certificate request.
12083
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012084disabled
12085 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12086 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12087 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12088 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12089 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012090 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012091
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012092enabled
12093 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12094 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12095 default value.
12096 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12097 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012099error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012100 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12101 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12102 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012104 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012106fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12108 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12109 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12110
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012111force-sslv3
12112 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12113 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012114 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012115 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012116
12117force-tlsv10
12118 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012119 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012120 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012121
12122force-tlsv11
12123 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012124 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012125 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012126
12127force-tlsv12
12128 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012129 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012130 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012131
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012132force-tlsv13
12133 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12134 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012135 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012137id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012138 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12139 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12140 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012141
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012142init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12143 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12144 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012146 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12147 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12148 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12149 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12150 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12151 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12152 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12153 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12154 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012155 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012156 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12157 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12158 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12159 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12160 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12161 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012162 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012163
12164 Example:
12165 defaults
12166 # never fail on address resolution
12167 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012169inter <delay>
12170fastinter <delay>
12171downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012172 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12173 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12174 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12175 between checks depending on the server state :
12176
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012177 Server state | Interval used
12178 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12179 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12180 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12181 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12182 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12183 or yet unchecked. |
12184 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12185 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12186 | "inter" otherwise.
12187 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012189 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12190 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12191 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12192 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012193 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12194 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12195 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12196 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12197 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012199maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012200 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12201 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012202 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12203 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12205 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12206 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12207 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12208
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012209 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12210 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12211 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12212 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12213 than 50 concurrent requests.
12214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012215maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012216 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12217 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12218 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12219 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12220 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12221 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12222 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12223
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012224max-reuse <count>
12225 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12226 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12227 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12228 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12229 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12230 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12231 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12232 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12233
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012234minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012235 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12236 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12237 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12238 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12239 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12240 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012241 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012242 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012243
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012244namespace <name>
12245 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12246 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12247 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12248 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12249
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012250no-agent-check
12251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12253 default value.
12254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12255 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12256
12257no-backup
12258 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12259 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12260 default value.
12261 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12262 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12263
12264no-check
12265 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12266 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12267 default value.
12268 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12269 "default-server" "check" setting.
12270
12271no-check-ssl
12272 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12273 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12274 default value.
12275 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12276 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12277
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012278no-send-proxy
12279 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12280 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12281 default value.
12282 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12283 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12284
12285no-send-proxy-v2
12286 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12287 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12288 default value.
12289 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12290 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12291
12292no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12293 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12294 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12295 default value.
12296 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12297 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12298
12299no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12300 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12301 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12302 default value.
12303 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12304 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12305
12306no-ssl
12307 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12308 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12309 default value.
12310 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12311 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12312
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012313no-ssl-reuse
12314 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12315 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12316 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12317 and for paranoid users.
12318
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012319no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012320 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12321 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012322 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012323
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012324 Supported in default-server: No
12325
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012326no-tls-tickets
12327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12328 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12329 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012330 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12331 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012332 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012333
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012334no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012335 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012336 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12337 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012338 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12339 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012340 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012341
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012342 Supported in default-server: No
12343
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012344no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012345 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012346 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12347 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012348 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12349 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012350 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012351
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012352 Supported in default-server: No
12353
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012354no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012355 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012356 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12357 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012358 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12359 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012360 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012361
12362 Supported in default-server: No
12363
12364no-tlsv13
12365 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12366 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12367 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12368 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12369 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012370 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012371
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012372 Supported in default-server: No
12373
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012374no-verifyhost
12375 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12376 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12377 default value.
12378 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12379 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012380
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012381no-tfo
12382 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12383 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12384 default value.
12385 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12386 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12387
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012388non-stick
12389 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12390 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12391 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12392
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012393npn <protocols>
12394 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12395 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12396 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012397 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012398 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12399 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12400 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012402observe <mode>
12403 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12404 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12405 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12406 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12407 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12408 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012409 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012410
12411 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012413on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012414 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12415 Currently, four modes are available:
12416 - fastinter: force fastinter
12417 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12418 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12419 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12420 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12421
12422 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12423
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012424on-marked-down <action>
12425 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12426 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012427 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12428 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12429 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12430 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12431 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12432 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12433 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12434 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012435
12436 Actions are disabled by default
12437
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012438on-marked-up <action>
12439 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12440 Currently one action is available:
12441 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12442 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12443 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12444 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012445 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12446 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012447 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12448 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12449
12450 Actions are disabled by default
12451
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012452pool-max-conn <max>
12453 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12454 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12455 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12456 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12457 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12458 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12459
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012460pool-purge-delay <delay>
12461 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012462 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012463 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012465port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012466 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12467 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12468 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12469 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12470 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12471 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12472
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012473proto <name>
12474
12475 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12476 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12477 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12478 reported in haproxy -vv.
12479 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12480 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012482redir <prefix>
12483 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12484 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12485 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12486 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12487 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12488 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12489 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12490 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012491 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012492 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012493 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12494 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12495 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12496 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12497
12498 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012500rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012501 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12502 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12503 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12504
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012505resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12506 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12507 server.
12508
12509 Available options:
12510
12511 * allow-dup-ip
12512 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12513 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12514 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12515 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12516 For such case, simply enable this option.
12517 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12518
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012519 * ignore-weight
12520 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12521 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12522 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12523
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012524 * prevent-dup-ip
12525 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12526 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12527 same fqdn.
12528 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12529
12530 Example:
12531 backend b_myapp
12532 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12533 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12534 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12535
12536 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12537 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12538 it
12539 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12540 different address
12541
12542 Default value: not set
12543
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012544resolve-prefer <family>
12545 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12546 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12547 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12548 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12549
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012550 Default value: ipv6
12551
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012552 Example:
12553
12554 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012555
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012556resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012557 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012558 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012559 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012560 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12561 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012562 configured network, another address is selected.
12563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012564 Example:
12565
12566 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012567
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012568resolvers <id>
12569 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12570 hostname.
12571
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012572 Example:
12573
12574 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012576 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012577
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012578send-proxy
12579 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12580 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12581 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12582 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012583 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12584 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12585 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12586 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12587 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12588 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12589 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12590 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12591 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12592 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012593 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12594 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012595
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012596send-proxy-v2
12597 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12598 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12599 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12600 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012601 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12602 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12603 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12604 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012605
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012606proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12607 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12608 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012609 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12610 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012611 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12612 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012613 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012614
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012615send-proxy-v2-ssl
12616 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12617 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12618 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12619 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12620 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12621 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12622 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012623 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12624 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012625
12626send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12627 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12628 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12629 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12630 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12631 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12632 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12633 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12634 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12636 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012638slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012639 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12640 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12641 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12642 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12643 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12644 parameters :
12645
12646 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12647 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12648
12649 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12650 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12651 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12652 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12653
12654 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12655 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12656 seen as failed.
12657
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012658sni <expression>
12659 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12660 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12661 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12662 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012663 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12664 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012665 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012666 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12667 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012668
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012669source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012670source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012671source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012672 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12673 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12674 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12675 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12676
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012677 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12678 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12679 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12680 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12681 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12682 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12683 server.
12684
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012685 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12686 specifying the source address without port(s).
12687
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012688ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012689 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12690 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12691 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12692 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12693 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12694 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012695 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12696 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012697
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012698ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12699 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12700 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12701 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12702
12703ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12704 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12705 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12706 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12707
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012708ssl-reuse
12709 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12710 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12711 default value.
12712 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12713 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12714
12715stick
12716 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12717 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12718 default value.
12719 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12720 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012721
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012722socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012723 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012724 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12725 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12726
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012727tcp-ut <delay>
12728 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12729 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12730 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012731 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012732 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12733 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12734 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12735 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12736 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12737 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12738 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12739 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12740 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12741
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012742tfo
12743 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12744 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12745 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12746 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12747 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012748 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012750track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012751 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12752 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12753 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12754 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012755 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12756
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012757tls-tickets
12758 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12759 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12760 default value.
12761 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12762 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012763
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012764verify [none|required]
12765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012766 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012767 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12768 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012769 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012770 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12771 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12772 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12773 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12774 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12775 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12776 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12777 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012778
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012779verifyhost <hostname>
12780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012781 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12782 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12783 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12784 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12785 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12786 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12787 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12788 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012790weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012791 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12792 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12793 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012794 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12795 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12796 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12797 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12798 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12799 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012800
12801
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128025.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12803-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012804
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012805HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12806using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12807configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012808This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12809can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12810workload.
12811This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12812resolution at run time.
12813Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12814carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12815
12816
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128175.3.1. Global overview
12818----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012819
12820As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12821different steps of the process life:
12822
12823 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12824 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12825 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12826
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012827 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12828 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012829
12830A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12831 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12832 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12833 resolution to know this new IP.
12834
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012835When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012836HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012837SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12838from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12839will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12840will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012841
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012842A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012843 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012844 first valid response.
12845
12846 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12847 servers return an error.
12848
12849
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128505.3.2. The resolvers section
12851----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012852
12853This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012854HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12855contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012856
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012857When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12858uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12859is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12860answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12861
12862When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012863used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012864
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012865 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12866 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12867 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012868
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012869 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12870 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012871
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012872 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12873 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12874 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012875
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012876For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12877following scenarios are possible:
12878
12879 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12880 ignored
12881
12882 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12883 applied
12884
12885 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12886 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12887
12888 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12889 retries the query with a new type
12890
12891 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12892 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012893
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012894As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12895a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012896<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012897
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012898
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012899resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012900 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012901
12902A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12903
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012904accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012905 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012906 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012907 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12908 by RFC 6891)
12909
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012910 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12911
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012912nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12913 DNS server description:
12914 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12915 <ip> : IP address of the server
12916 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12917
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012918parse-resolv-conf
12919 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12920 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12921 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12922
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012923hold <status> <period>
12924 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12925 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012926 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012927 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012928 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12929 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12930 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12931
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012932 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012933
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012934resolve_retries <nb>
12935 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12936 giving up.
12937 Default value: 3
12938
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012939 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12940 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12941 type.
12942
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012943timeout <event> <time>
12944 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12945 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12946 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012947 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12948 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012949 Default value: 1s
12950 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012951 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012952 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012953 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12954 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12955
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012956 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012957
12958 resolvers mydns
12959 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12960 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012961 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012962 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012963 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012964 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012965 hold other 30s
12966 hold refused 30s
12967 hold nx 30s
12968 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012969 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012970 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012971
12972
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200129736. Cache
12974---------
12975
12976HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12977(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12978RAM.
12979
12980The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12981this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12982
12983If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12984independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12985when we try to allocate a new one.
12986
12987The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12988
12989It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12990"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12991for more details.
12992
12993When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12994replaced by "<CACHE>".
12995
12996
129976.1. Limitation
12998----------------
12999
13000The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13001
13002- If the response is not a 200
13003- If the response contains a Vary header
13004- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13005- If the response is not cacheable
13006
13007- If the request is not a GET
13008- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13009- If the request contains an Authorization header
13010
13011
130126.2. Setup
13013-----------
13014
13015To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13016the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13017
13018
130196.2.1. Cache section
13020---------------------
13021
13022cache <name>
13023 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13024 size of cache is mandatory.
13025
13026total-max-size <megabytes>
13027 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13028 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13029
13030max-object-size <bytes>
13031 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13032 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13033 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13034
13035max-age <seconds>
13036 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13037 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13038 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13039 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13040 default.
13041
13042
130436.2.2. Proxy section
13044---------------------
13045
13046http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13047 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13048 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13049 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13050 after this one.
13051
13052http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13053 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13054 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13055 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13056 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13057
13058
13059Example:
13060
13061 backend bck1
13062 mode http
13063
13064 http-request cache-use foobar
13065 http-response cache-store foobar
13066 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13067
13068 cache foobar
13069 total-max-size 4
13070 max-age 240
13071
13072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13074----------------------------------
13075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13078The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13079these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13080but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13081data called patterns.
13082
13083
130847.1. ACL basics
13085---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013086
13087The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13088content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13089from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13090simple :
13091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013093 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013094 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13095 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13098adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013099
13100In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013103
13104This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13105Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13106and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013107an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13108conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13109as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13110are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013111
13112ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13113'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13114which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13115
13116There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13117performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013119The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13120specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13121this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013122methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13123ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124
13125Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13126 - boolean
13127 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13128 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13129 - string
13130 - data block
13131
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013132Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13133converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13134would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13135The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13136which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13137
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013138Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13139keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13140fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13141which are summarized in the table below :
13142
13143 +---------------------+-----------------+
13144 | Sample or converter | Default |
13145 | output type | matching method |
13146 +---------------------+-----------------+
13147 | boolean | bool |
13148 +---------------------+-----------------+
13149 | integer | int |
13150 +---------------------+-----------------+
13151 | ip | ip |
13152 +---------------------+-----------------+
13153 | string | str |
13154 +---------------------+-----------------+
13155 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13156 +---------------------+-----------------+
13157
13158Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13159matching method, see below.
13160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13162 - boolean
13163 - integer or integer range
13164 - IP address / network
13165 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13166 - regular expression
13167 - hex block
13168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013169The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13170
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013171 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13172 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013173 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013174 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013175 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013176 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013177 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013179The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13180read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13181if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13182lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13183will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13184beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13185a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13186lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13187exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13188
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013189The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13190parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13191ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13192a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13193check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13194
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013195The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13196socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13197file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13200loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13201
13202 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13203
13204In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13205the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13206case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13207as well.
13208
13209The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13210sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13211do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13212methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13213is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013214obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13216default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13217that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13218string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13219
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013220The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13221By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13222string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13223resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13224server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013225waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013226flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13227function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13230sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13231be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013232
13233 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13234 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13236 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13237 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13238 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013239
13240 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13241 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013242 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013243
13244 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013245 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013246
13247 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013248 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013250 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013251 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13252
13253 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13254 binary or string samples.
13255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013256 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13257 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013259 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13260 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13261 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13264 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13267 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13270 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013272 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13273 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013274 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13277 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13278 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013279
13280For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13281request, it is possible to do :
13282
13283 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13284
13285In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13286buffer, one would use the following acl :
13287
13288 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13289
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013290On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13291possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13292
13293 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013295All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13296criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13297method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13298to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13299criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13300the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013303the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13304For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013306 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13307 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13308 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13309 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013310
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013311
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013312The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13313types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13314combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13315brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13316default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318 +-------------------------------------------------+
13319 | Input sample type |
13320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013321 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13323 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013325 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013327 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013329 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013331 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013332 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013333 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013335 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013336 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013337 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013339 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013341 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013343 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013345 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13347 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13348 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013349
13350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133517.1.1. Matching booleans
13352------------------------
13353
13354In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13355Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13356When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13357that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13358
13359Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13360return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13361"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13362
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133647.1.2. Matching integers
13365------------------------
13366
13367Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13368enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13369to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13370
13371Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13372matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13373lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013374
13375For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13376unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13377representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13378
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013379As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13380two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13381instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13382ranges and operators.
13383
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013384For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013385operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13386Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13387of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013389Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013390
13391 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13392 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13393 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13394 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13395 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013397For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013398
13399 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13400
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013401This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13402
13403 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13404
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134067.1.3. Matching strings
13407-----------------------
13408
13409String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13410different forms :
13411
13412 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013414
13415 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013416 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013417
13418 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13419 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13420
13421 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13422 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13423
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013424 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13426 matches.
13427
13428 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13429 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13430 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013431
13432String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13433exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13434characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13435string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13436to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013437before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013438
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013439Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13440(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13441Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13442
13443Example:
13444 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13445 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134487.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13449---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013450
13451Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13452they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13453possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13454passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13455the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013456the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13457match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013458
13459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134607.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13461-------------------------------------
13462
13463It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13464not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13465a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13466to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13467digits may be used upper or lower case.
13468
13469Example :
13470 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13471 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13472
13473
134747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13475---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013476
13477IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13478netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13479within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013480host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013481difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13482at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13483does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13484parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013485
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013486The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13487abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13488
13489 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13490 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13491 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13492 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13493 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13494 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13495 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13496 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13497
13498Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13499192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13500
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013501IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13502Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13503trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13504IPv6 patterns.
13505
13506HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13507following situations :
13508 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13509 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13510 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13511 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13512 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13513 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13514 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13515 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13516 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13517 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013519
135207.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13521----------------------------------
13522
13523Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13524combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13525
13526 - AND (implicit)
13527 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13528 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013532 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13535indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13538"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13539requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13540is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13541
13542 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013543 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13544 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13545 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546
13547To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13548and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13549
13550 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13551 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13552 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13553 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13554
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013555 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13557 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13558 use_backend www if host_www
13559
13560It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13561expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13562be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13563the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13564
13565 The following rule :
13566
13567 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013568 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569
13570 Can also be written that way :
13571
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013572 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013573
13574It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13575to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13576simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13577sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13578good use is the following :
13579
13580 With named ACLs :
13581
13582 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13583 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13584 monitor fail if site_dead
13585
13586 With anonymous ACLs :
13587
13588 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13589
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013590See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13591keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013592
13593
135947.3. Fetching samples
13595---------------------
13596
13597Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13598against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13599sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13600ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13601of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13602available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13603
13604This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13605Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13606compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13607deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13608
13609The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13610matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13611method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13612indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13613
13614As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13615when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13616mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13617the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13618ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13619
13620Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13621multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13622when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013623incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13624are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13626all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13627
13628Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13629 - name
13630 - name(arg1)
13631 - name(arg1,arg2)
13632
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013633
136347.3.1. Converters
13635-----------------
13636
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013637Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13638of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13639is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13640was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013641has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013642unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13643
13644These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13645sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13646the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013647support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013648
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013649A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13650support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13651supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13652(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13653bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013655The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013656
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001365751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13658 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13659 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13660 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13661 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13662 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13663
13664 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013665 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13666 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013667 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13668 frontend http-in
13669 bind *:8081
13670 default_backend servers
13671 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13672 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13673
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013674add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013675 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013676 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013677 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13678 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013679 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013680 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13681 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013686
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013687aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13688 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13689 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13690 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13691 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13692 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13693 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13694
13695 Example:
13696 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13697 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13698
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013699and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013700 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013701 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013702 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13703 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013704 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013705 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13706 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13707 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13708 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013709 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013710 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013711
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013712b64dec
13713 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13714 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13715
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013716base64
13717 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013719 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13720
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013721bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013722 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013723 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013724 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013725 presence of a flag).
13726
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013727bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13728 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13729 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013730 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013731
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013732concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13733 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13734 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13735 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13736 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13737 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13738 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13739 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13740 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13741 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13742 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013743 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013744 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013745 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013746
13747 Example:
13748 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13749 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13750 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13751 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13752
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013753cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013754 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13755 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013756
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013757crc32([<avalanche>])
13758 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13759 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13760 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13761 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13762 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13763 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13764 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13765 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13766 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13767 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013768 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13769
13770crc32c([<avalanche>])
13771 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13772 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13773 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13774 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13775 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13776 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13777 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13778 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013779
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013780da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013781 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13782 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13783 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13784 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013785 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013786 configuration language.
13787
13788 Example:
13789 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013790 bind *:8881
13791 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013792 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013793
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013794debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13795 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13796 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13797 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13798 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13799 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13800 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13801 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13802 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13803 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13804 printable sample types.
13805
13806 Example:
13807 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013808
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013809div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013810 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13811 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013812 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013813 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13814 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013815 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013816 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13817 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13818 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013821 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013822
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013823djb2([<avalanche>])
13824 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13825 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13826 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13827 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13828 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13829 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13830 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013831 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13832 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013834even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013835 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013836 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13837
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013838field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13839 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13840 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13841 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13842 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13843 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13844 fields.
13845
13846 Example :
13847 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13848 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13849 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13850 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13851 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013853hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013854 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013855 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013856 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013857 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013858
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013859hex2i
13860 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013861 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013862
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013863http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013864 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13865 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013866 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13867 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13868 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13869 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13870 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13871 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13872 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13873 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013875in_table(<table>)
13876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13878 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013879 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013880 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13881
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013882ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13883 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013884 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013885 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13886 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13887 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13888 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13889 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013890
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013891json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013892 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013893 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013894 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013895 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13896 of errors:
13897 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13898 bytes, ...)
13899 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13900 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13901
13902 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13903 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13904 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13905 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13906 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13907 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013908 - "ascii" : never fails;
13909 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13910 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013911 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013912 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013913 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13914 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13915
13916 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013917 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013918
13919 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013920 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013921 capture request header user-agent len 150
13922 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013923
13924 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13925 GET / HTTP/1.0
13926 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13927
13928 Output log:
13929 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013931language(<value>[,<default>])
13932 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13933 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13934 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13935 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13936 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13937 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13938 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13939 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13940 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013941 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013942 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13943 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013944
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013945 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013946
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013947 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13948 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013949
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013950 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13951 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13952 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13953 use_backend spanish if es
13954 use_backend french if fr
13955 use_backend english if en
13956 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013957
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013958length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013959 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13960 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13961 type. The result is of type integer.
13962
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013963lower
13964 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13965 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13966 type. The result is of type string.
13967
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013968ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13969 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13970 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13971 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13972 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13973 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13974 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13975
13976 Example :
13977
13978 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013980 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13981
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013982map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13983map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13984map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13985 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13986 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13987 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13988 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13989 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13990 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13991 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13992 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013993
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013994 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13995 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13996 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013997
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013998 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013999 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014000
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014001 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14002 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14003 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14004 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014005 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14006 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014007 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14008 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14009 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14010 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14011 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14012 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14013 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14014 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014015 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14016 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14017 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014018 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14019 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14020 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14021 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14022 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014023
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014024 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14025 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14026 the corresponding match text.
14027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014028 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14029 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14030 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14031 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14032 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014033
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014034 Example :
14035
14036 # this is a comment and is ignored
14037 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14038 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14039 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14040 | | | `---------- value
14041 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14042 | `---------------------------- key
14043 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14044
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014045mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014046 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14047 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014048 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014049 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014050 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014051 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14052 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14053 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14054 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014055 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014056 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014057
14058mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014059 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014060 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14061 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014062 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014063 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014064 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14068 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014069 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014070 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014071
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014072nbsrv
14073 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14074 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14075 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14076 map lookup.
14077
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014078neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014079 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14080 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14081 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14082 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014083
14084not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014085 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014086 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014088 absence of a flag).
14089
14090odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014091 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014092 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14093
14094or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014095 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014096 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014097 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14098 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014099 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014100 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14101 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14102 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14103 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014105 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014106
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014107protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14108 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14109 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14110 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14111 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14112 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14113 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14114 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14115 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14116 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14117 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14118 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14119
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014120regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014121 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14122 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14123 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14124 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14125 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14126 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14127 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14128 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14129 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14130 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014131 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14132 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14133 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14134 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014135
14136 Example :
14137
14138 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14139 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14140 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14141 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14142
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014143capture-req(<id>)
14144 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14145 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14146
14147 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014148 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14149 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014150
14151capture-res(<id>)
14152 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14153 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14154
14155 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014156 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14157 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014158
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014159sdbm([<avalanche>])
14160 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14161 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14162 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14163 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14164 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14165 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14166 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014167 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14168 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014169
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014170set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014171 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14172 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14173 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014174 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014175 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14176 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014177 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014178 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14179 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014180 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014181 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014182
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014183sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014184 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014185 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14186
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014187sha2([<bits>])
14188 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14189 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14190
14191 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14192 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14193
14194 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14195 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14196
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014197srv_queue
14198 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14199 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14200 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14201 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14202 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14203
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014204strcmp(<var>)
14205 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14206 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14207 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14208 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14209 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14210 shorter).
14211
14212 Example :
14213
14214 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14215 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14216 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14217
14218
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014219sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014220 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14221 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014222 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014223 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14224 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14227 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014228 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14230 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014231 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014232 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014233
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014234table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14235 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14236 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14237 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14238 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14239 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14240 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14241
14242
14243table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14246 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14247 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14248 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14249 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14250
14251table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14252 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14253 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014254 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014255 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14256 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14257
14258table_conn_cur(<table>)
14259 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14260 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14261 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14262 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14263 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14264
14265table_conn_rate(<table>)
14266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14268 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14269 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14270 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14271
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014272table_gpt0(<table>)
14273 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14274 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14275 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14276 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14277 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14278
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014279table_gpc0(<table>)
14280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14283 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14284 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14285
14286table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14289 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14290 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14291 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14292 sample fetch keyword.
14293
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014294table_gpc1(<table>)
14295 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14296 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14297 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14298 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14299 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14300
14301table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14302 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14303 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14304 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14305 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14306 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14307 sample fetch keyword.
14308
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014309table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14310 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14311 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014312 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014313 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14314 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14315
14316table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14317 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14318 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14319 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14320 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14321 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14322 keyword.
14323
14324table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14325 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14326 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014327 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014328 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14329 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14330
14331table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14334 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14335 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14336 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14337 keyword.
14338
14339table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14340 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14341 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014342 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014343 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14344 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14345 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14346 keyword.
14347
14348table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014352 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14353 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14354 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14355 keyword.
14356
14357table_server_id(<table>)
14358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14361 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14362 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14363 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14364
14365table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14366 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14367 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014368 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014369 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14370 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14371 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14372 keyword.
14373
14374table_sess_rate(<table>)
14375 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14376 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14377 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14378 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14379 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14380 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14381 keyword.
14382
14383table_trackers(<table>)
14384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14387 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14388 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14389 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14390 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14391 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14392 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14393 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14394
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014395upper
14396 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14397 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14398 type. The result is of type string.
14399
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014400url_dec
14401 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14402 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14403
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014404ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014405 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014406 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14407 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14408 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014409 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14410 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14411 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14412 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014413 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014414 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14415 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014416
14417 Example:
14418 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14419 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14420
14421 message Point {
14422 int32 latitude = 1;
14423 int32 longitude = 2;
14424 }
14425
14426 message PPoint {
14427 Point point = 59;
14428 }
14429
14430 message Rectangle {
14431 // One corner of the rectangle.
14432 PPoint lo = 48;
14433 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14434 PPoint hi = 49;
14435 }
14436
14437 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14438 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14439 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14440
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014441 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14442 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014443 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014444 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14445
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014446 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014447
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014448 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014449
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014450 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014451 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14452 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14453
14454 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14455 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14456 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14457
14458 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14459 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14460 interpret the previous binary sample.
14461
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014462
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014463unset-var(<var name>)
14464 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14465 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14466 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14467 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14468 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14469 response),
14470 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14471 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14472 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14473 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14474
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014475utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14476 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14477 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14478 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14479 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14480 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14481 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14482
14483 Example :
14484
14485 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014486 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014487 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14488
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014489word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14490 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14491 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14492 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014493 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014494 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14495 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14496
14497 Example :
14498 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14499 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14500 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14501 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14502 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014503 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014504
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014505wt6([<avalanche>])
14506 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14507 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14508 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14509 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14510 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14511 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14512 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014513 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14514 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014515
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014516xor(<value>)
14517 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014518 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014519 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014520 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014521 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014522 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14523 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014524 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014525 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14526 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014527 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014528 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014529
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014530xxh32([<seed>])
14531 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14532 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14533 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14534 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14535 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14536 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14537 as cryptographically secure.
14538
14539xxh64([<seed>])
14540 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14541 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14542 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14543 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14544 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14545 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14546 as cryptographically secure.
14547
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145497.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550--------------------------------------------
14551
14552A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14553not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14554"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14555The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14556
14557always_false : boolean
14558 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14559 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14560
14561always_true : boolean
14562 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14563 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14564
14565avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014566 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14568 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14569 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14570 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14571 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14572 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14573 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14574 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14575 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14576 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14577 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14578 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14579 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014582 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14583 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14584 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14585 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014586 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14587
14588be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14589 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14590 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14591 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14592 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14593 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014594 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14595 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014596
14597 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14598 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14599 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14602 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14603 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14604 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014605 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14607 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014608
14609 Example :
14610 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14611 backend dynamic
14612 mode http
14613 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14614 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014616bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014617 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14618 of the string.
14619
14620bool(<bool>) : bool
14621 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14622 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014624connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014626 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14628 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014629
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014630 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014631 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014632 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14633
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014634 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14635 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014636
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014637 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014638 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014640 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014641 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014642 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014643 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014644
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014645 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14646 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014648 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014649
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014650cpu_calls : integer
14651 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14652 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14653 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14654 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14655 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14656 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14657
14658cpu_ns_avg : integer
14659 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14660 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14661 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14662 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14663 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14664 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14665 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14666 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14667 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14668 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14669 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14670
14671cpu_ns_tot : integer
14672 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14673 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14674 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14675 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14676 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14677 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14678 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14679 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14680 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14681 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14682 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14683 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14684 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14685
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014686date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014687 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014688
14689 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14690 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14691 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014692 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14693
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014694 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14695 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14696 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14697 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14698 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14699
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014700 Example :
14701
14702 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14703 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014704
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014705 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14706 # millisecond granularity
14707 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14708
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014709date_us : integer
14710 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14711 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14712 from the same timeval structure.
14713
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014714distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14715 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14716 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14717 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14718 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14719 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14720 list of supported tokens.
14721
14722distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14723 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14724 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14725 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14726 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14727 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14728 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14729 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14730 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14731 supported tokens.
14732
14733 Example :
14734 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14735 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14736 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14737 # send large files to the big farm
14738 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14739
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014740env(<name>) : string
14741 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14742 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14743 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14744 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14745 certain way.
14746
14747 Examples :
14748 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14749 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14750
14751 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14752 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14755 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014756 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14757 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14759 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014760 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14762 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014763
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014764fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14765 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14766 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14767 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14770 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14771 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14772 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14773 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14774 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14775 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14776 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14777 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014778
14779 Example :
14780 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14781 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14782 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14783 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14784 frontend mail
14785 bind :25
14786 mode tcp
14787 maxconn 100
14788 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14789 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14790 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14791 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014792
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014793hostname : string
14794 Returns the system hostname.
14795
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014796int(<integer>) : signed integer
14797 Returns a signed integer.
14798
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014799ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14800 Returns an ipv4.
14801
14802ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14803 Returns an ipv6.
14804
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014805lat_ns_avg : integer
14806 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14807 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14808 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14809 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14810 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14811 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14812 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14813 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14814 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14815 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14816 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14817 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14818 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14819 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14820
14821lat_ns_tot : integer
14822 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14823 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14824 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14825 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14826 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14827 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14828 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14829 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14830 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14831 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14832 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14833 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14834 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14835 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14836 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14837 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14838 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14839 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14840 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14841
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014842meth(<method>) : method
14843 Returns a method.
14844
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014845nbproc : integer
14846 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14847 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14848 and debugging purposes.
14849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14851 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14852 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14853 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014854 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14855 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14856 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014857
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014858prio_class : integer
14859 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14860 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14861 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14862
14863prio_offset : integer
14864 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14865 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14866 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14867 set-priority-offset".
14868
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014869proc : integer
14870 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14871 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14872 debugging purposes.
14873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014875 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14876 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14877 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14879 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14880 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14881 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14882 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14883
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014884rand([<range>]) : integer
14885 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14886 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14887 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14888 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14889 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14890
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014891uuid([<version>]) : string
14892 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14893 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14894 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14897 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14898 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14899 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14900 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14901 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014902 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14903 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14904
14905srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14906 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14907 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14908 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14909 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14910 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14911 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14912 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14913
14914 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14915 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916
14917srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14918 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14919 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14920 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014921 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14923 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14924 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14925
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014926srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14927 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14928 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14929 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14930 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14931 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14932 fetch methods.
14933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14935 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14936 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014937 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14939 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014940 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941 overloading servers).
14942
14943 Example :
14944 # Redirect to a separate back
14945 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14946 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14947 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14948
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014949stopping : boolean
14950 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14951 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14952 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14953
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014954str(<string>) : string
14955 Returns a string.
14956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14958 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14959 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14960
14961table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14962 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14963 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14964 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14965
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014966thread : integer
14967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14968 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14969 and debugging purposes.
14970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014971var(<var-name>) : undefined
14972 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014973 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14974 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014975 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014976 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14977 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014978 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014979 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14980 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014982 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014983
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149847.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985----------------------------------
14986
14987The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14988closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14989methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14990sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14991TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014992the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14993counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014994"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14995used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14996can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14997Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14998table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14999tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15000currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015002bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015003 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15004 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15005 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007be_id : integer
15008 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15009 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15010
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015011be_name : string
15012 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15013 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015dst : ip
15016 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15017 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15018 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15019 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015020 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15021 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15022 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15023 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15024 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15025 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026
15027dst_conn : integer
15028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15029 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15030 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15031 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15032 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15033 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15034 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15035 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015036
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015037dst_is_local : boolean
15038 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15039 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15040 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15041 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015042 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015043 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15044 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15045 it only once per connection.
15046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015047dst_port : integer
15048 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15049 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15050 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15051 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15052 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15053 an HTTP header.
15054
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015055fc_http_major : integer
15056 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15057 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15058 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15059
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015060fc_pp_authority : string
15061 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15062 if any.
15063
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015064fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15065 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15066 header.
15067
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015068fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15069 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15070 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15071 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15072 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15073 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15074 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15075
15076fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15077 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15078 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15079 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15080 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15081 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15082 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15083
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015084fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015085 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15086 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15087 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15088 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15089
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015090fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015091 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15092 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15093 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15094 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15095
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015096fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015097 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15098 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15099 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15100 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15101
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015102fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015103 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15104 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15105 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15106 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15107
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015108fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015109 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15110 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15111 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15112 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15113
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015114fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015115 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15116 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15117 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15118 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15119
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015120fe_defbe : string
15121 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15122 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124fe_id : integer
15125 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015126 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15128
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015129fe_name : string
15130 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15131 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15132 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15133
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015134sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015135sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15136sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15137sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015138 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15139 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15140 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015142sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015143sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15144sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15145sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015146 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15147 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15148 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15149
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015150sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015151sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15152sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15153sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015154 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15155 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015156 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15157 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15158 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015159
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015160 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015161 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15162 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015163 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15164 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15165 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015166 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15167 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15168
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015169sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15170sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15171sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15172sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15173 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15174 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15175 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15176 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15177 when a first ACL was verified.
15178
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015179sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015180sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15181sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15182sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015184 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15185
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015186sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015187sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15188sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15189sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015190 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15191 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15192 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15193
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015194sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015195sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15196sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15197sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015198 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15199 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15200 See also src_conn_rate.
15201
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015202sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015203sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15204sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15205sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015206 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015207 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015208
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015209sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15210sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15211sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15212sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15213 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15214 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15215
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015216sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15217sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15218sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15219sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15220 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15221 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15222
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015223sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015224sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15225sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15226sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015227 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15228 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15229 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015230 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15231 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15232 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015233
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015234sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15235sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15236sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15237sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15238 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15239 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15240 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15241 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15242 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15243 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15244
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015245sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015246sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15247sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15248sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015249 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015250 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15251 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015253sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015254sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15255sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15256sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015257 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15258 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15259 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15260 src_http_err_rate.
15261
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015262sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015263sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15264sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15265sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015267 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15268 src_http_req_cnt.
15269
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015270sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015271sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15272sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15273sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015274 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15275 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15276 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15277 src_http_req_rate.
15278
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015279sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015280sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15281sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15282sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015283 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015284 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15285 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15286 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15287 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015288
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015289 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015290 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15291 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015292 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15293
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015294sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15295sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15296sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15297sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15298 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15299 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15300 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15301 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15302 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15303
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015304sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015305sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15306sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15307sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015308 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15309 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15310 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015311
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015312sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015313sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15314sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15315sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015316 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15317 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15318 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015320sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015321sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15322sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15323sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015324 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015325 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15326 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15327 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015328 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015329 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15330
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015331sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015332sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15333sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15334sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015335 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15336 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15337 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15338 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15339 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015340 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015341
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015342sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015343sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15344sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15345sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015346 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15347 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15348 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15349
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015350sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015351sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15352sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15353sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015354 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15355 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015356 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015357 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15358 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15360 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15361 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015363so_id : integer
15364 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15365 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15366 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015369 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15371 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15372 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015373 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15374 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15375 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015376 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15377 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15378 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15379 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15380 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15381 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15382 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015383
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015384 Example:
15385 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15386 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15389 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15390 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15391 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015392 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15396 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015397 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015398 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15401 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15402 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15403 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15404 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15405 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15406 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015407
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015408 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015409 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15410 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15411 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15412 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015413 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015414 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15415 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15416
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015417src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15418 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15419 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15420 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15421 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15422 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15423 was verified.
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015426 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015428 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015429 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015432 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15434 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015435 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15438 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15439 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15440 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015441 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015444 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015446 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015447 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015448
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015449src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15450 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15451 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15452 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15453 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15454
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015455src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15456 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15457 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15458 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15459 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015462 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015464 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15465 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015466 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15467 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15468 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015469
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015470src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15471 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15472 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15473 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15474 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15475 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15476 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15477 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015480 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015482 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015483 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15487 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15488 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15489 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15490 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015491 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015494 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15496 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015497 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15500 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15501 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15502 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015503 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015504 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15507 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15508 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15509 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015510 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15512 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015513
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015514 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015515 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015516 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015517 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015518
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015519src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15520 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15521 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15522 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15523 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15524 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15525 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15526
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015527src_is_local : boolean
15528 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15529 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15530 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15531 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015532 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015533 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15534 once per connection.
15535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015537 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15538 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15539 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15540 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15541 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015544 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15545 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15546 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15547 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15548 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550src_port : integer
15551 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15552 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15553 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15554 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015557 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015558 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15559 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15560 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015561 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15564 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15565 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15566 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15567 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015568 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15571 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15572 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15573 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15574 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15575 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15576 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15577 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15578 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015579
15580 Example :
15581 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15582 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15583 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15584 listen ssh
15585 bind :22
15586 mode tcp
15587 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015588 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015590 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592srv_id : integer
15593 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15594 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15595 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015596
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015597srv_name : string
15598 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15599 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15600 debugging.
15601
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156027.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15606closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15607when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15608usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015609future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015610
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001561151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15612 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15613 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15614 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15615 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15616 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15617
15618 Example :
15619 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15620 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15621 # the request.
15622 frontend http-in
15623 bind *:8081
15624 default_backend servers
15625 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15626 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15627
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015628ssl_bc : boolean
15629 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15630 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15631 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15632
15633ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15634 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15635 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15636
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015637ssl_bc_alpn : string
15638 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15639 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015640 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015641 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15642 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15643 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15644 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15645 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15646 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15647
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015648ssl_bc_cipher : string
15649 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15650 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15651
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015652ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15653 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15654 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15655 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15656
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015657ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15658 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15659 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15660 session or a TLS ticket.
15661
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015662ssl_bc_npn : string
15663 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15664 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015665 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015666 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15667 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15668 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15669 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15670 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15671
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015672ssl_bc_protocol : string
15673 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15674 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15675
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015676ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015677 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015678 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15679 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015680
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015681ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15682 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15683 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15684 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15685
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015686ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15687 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15688 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15689 if session was reused or not.
15690
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015691ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15692 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15693 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15694 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15695 BoringSSL.
15696
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015697ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15698 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15699 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15702 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15703 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15704 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15705 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15706 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15709 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15710 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15711 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15712 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015713
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015714ssl_c_der : binary
15715 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15716 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15717 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719ssl_c_err : integer
15720 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15721 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15722 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15723 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15724 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015725
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015726ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15728 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15729 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15730 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15731 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15732 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15733 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15734 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015735 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15736 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15737 LDAP v3.
15738 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15739 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741ssl_c_key_alg : string
15742 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15743 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15744 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746ssl_c_notafter : string
15747 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15748 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15749 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751ssl_c_notbefore : string
15752 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15753 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15754 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015755
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015756ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15758 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15759 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15760 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15761 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15762 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15763 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15764 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015765 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15766 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15767 LDAP v3.
15768 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15769 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771ssl_c_serial : binary
15772 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15773 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15774 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15777 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15778 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15779 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015780 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15781 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15782
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015783 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015784 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15787 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15788 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15789 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015791ssl_c_used : boolean
15792 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15793 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795ssl_c_verify : integer
15796 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15797 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15798 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15799 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801ssl_c_version : integer
15802 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15803 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015804
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015805ssl_f_der : binary
15806 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15807 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15808 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15809
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015810ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015811 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15812 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15813 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15814 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015815 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15817 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15818 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015819 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15820 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15821 LDAP v3.
15822 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15823 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825ssl_f_key_alg : string
15826 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15827 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15828 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830ssl_f_notafter : string
15831 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15832 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15833 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015835ssl_f_notbefore : string
15836 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15837 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15838 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015839
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015840ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15842 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15843 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15844 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15845 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15846 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15847 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15848 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015849 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15850 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15851 LDAP v3.
15852 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15853 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855ssl_f_serial : binary
15856 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15857 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15858 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015859
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015860ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15861 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15862 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15863 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15867 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15868 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870ssl_f_version : integer
15871 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15872 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15873
15874ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015875 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15876 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15877 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015879 Example :
15880 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15881 listen http-https
15882 bind :80
15883 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15884 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15885
15886ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15887 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15888 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15889
15890ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015891 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15893 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15894 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15895 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15896 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15897 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15898 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15899 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901ssl_fc_cipher : string
15902 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15903 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015904
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015905ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15906 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15907 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015908 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015909
15910ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15911 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15912 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015913 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015914
15915ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15916 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15917 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15918 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015919 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015920 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015921
15922ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15923 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15924 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015925 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015926
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015927ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15928 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15929 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15930 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015933 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15934 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015935 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15936 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15937 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15938 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015939
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015940ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15941 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15942 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15943 wait until the handshake happened.
15944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15946 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015947 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15948 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015949 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015950 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015951
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015952ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015953 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015954 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15955 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015958 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15960 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15961 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15962 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15963 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15964 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15965 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967ssl_fc_protocol : string
15968 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15969 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015970
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015971ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015972 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015973 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15974 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015975
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015976ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15977 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15978 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15979 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15982 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15983 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15984 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15985 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015986
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015987ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15988 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15989 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15990 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15991 BoringSSL.
15992
15993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994ssl_fc_sni : string
15995 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15996 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15997 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15998 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15999 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16000
16001 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16002 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16003 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016004 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016005 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16009 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16012 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16013 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016014
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16020sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16021only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16022For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16023be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16024can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16025sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16026for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16027content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016030 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16032 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16035 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016036 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016038
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016039req.hdrs : string
16040 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16041 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16042 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16043 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16044
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016045req.hdrs_bin : binary
16046 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16047 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16048 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16049 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16050 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16051 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16052
16053 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16054
16055 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16056 str: <int:length><bytes>
16057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058req.len : integer
16059req_len : integer (deprecated)
16060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16061 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16062 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16063 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16064 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16065 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16066 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16067 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16070 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016071 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16072 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16073 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16074 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076 ACL alternatives :
16077 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16080 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16081 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16082 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16083 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085 ACL alternatives :
16086 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090req.proto_http : boolean
16091req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16092 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16093 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16094 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16095 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16096 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16097 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16098 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 Example:
16101 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16102 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16103 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016104 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16107rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16108 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16109 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16110 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16111 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16112 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16113 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16114 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16117 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16118 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16119 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16120 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16121 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123 ACL derivatives :
16124 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 Example :
16127 listen tse-farm
16128 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16129 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16130 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16131 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16132 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16133 persist rdp-cookie
16134 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16135 # This is only useful makes sense if
16136 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16137 stick-table type string size 204800
16138 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16139 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16140 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16143 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16146rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16147 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16148 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16149 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16150 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 ACL derivatives :
16153 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016154
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016155req.ssl_alpn : string
16156 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16157 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16158 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16159 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16160 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16161 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016162 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016163
16164 Examples :
16165 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16166 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16167 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016168 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016169 default_backend bk_default
16170
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016171req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16172 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16173 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016174 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16175 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16176 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16177 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16178 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16181req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16182 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16183 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16184 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16185 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16186 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16187 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16188 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190req.ssl_sni : string
16191req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16192 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16193 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16194 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16195 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16196 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16197 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16198 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16199 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16200 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16201 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16202 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16203 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205 ACL derivatives :
16206 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208 Examples :
16209 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16210 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16211 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16212 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16213 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016214
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016215req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16216 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16217 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16218 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16219 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16220 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16221 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16222 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16223 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16224 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226req.ssl_ver : integer
16227req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16228 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16229 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16230 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16231 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16232 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16233 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16234 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016235 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238 ACL derivatives :
16239 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016240
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016241res.len : integer
16242 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16243 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16244 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16245 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16246 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16247 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16248 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16249 content inspection.
16250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16252 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016253 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16254 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16255 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16256 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16259 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16260 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16261 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16262 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016265
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016266res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16267rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16268 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16269 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16270 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16271 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16272 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16273 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16274 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276wait_end : boolean
16277 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16278 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016279 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16281 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016282 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16284 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 Examples :
16287 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16288 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16289 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16292 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16293 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16294 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16295 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16296 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16297 tcp-request content reject
16298
16299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163007.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016301--------------------------------------
16302
16303It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16304This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16305data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16306its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16307HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16308content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16309to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16310more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16311response are indexed.
16312
16313base : string
16314 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16315 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16316 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16317 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16318 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16319 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16320 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16321 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16322
16323 ACL derivatives :
16324 base : exact string match
16325 base_beg : prefix match
16326 base_dir : subdir match
16327 base_dom : domain match
16328 base_end : suffix match
16329 base_len : length match
16330 base_reg : regex match
16331 base_sub : substring match
16332
16333base32 : integer
16334 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16335 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16336 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016337 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16338 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16339 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340
16341base32+src : binary
16342 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16343 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16344 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16345 per-URL counters.
16346
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016347capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16348 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16349 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16350 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16351
16352capture.req.method : string
16353 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16354 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16355 because it's allocated.
16356
16357capture.req.uri : string
16358 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16359 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16360 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16361 allocated.
16362
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016363capture.req.ver : string
16364 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16365 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16366 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16367
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016368capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16369 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16370 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16371 The first entry is an index of 0.
16372 See also: "capture response header"
16373
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016374capture.res.ver : string
16375 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16376 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16377 persistent flag.
16378
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016379req.body : binary
16380 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16381 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16382 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16383 the first chunk is analyzed.
16384
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016385req.body_param([<name>) : string
16386 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16387 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16388 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16389 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16390 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16391 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16392 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16393 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16394 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16395 given.
16396
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016397req.body_len : integer
16398 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16399 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16400 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16401 "option http-buffer-request".
16402
16403req.body_size : integer
16404 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16405 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16406 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16407 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16408 "option http-buffer-request".
16409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016410req.cook([<name>]) : string
16411cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16412 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16413 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16414 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16415 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16416 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16417 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16418 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16419 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16420
16421 ACL derivatives :
16422 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16423 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16424 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16425 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16426 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16427 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16428 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16429 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016431req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16432cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16433 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16434 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16437cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16438 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16439 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16440 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16441 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16444 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16445 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16446 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16447 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016448 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016449 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16450 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16451 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16452 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16455 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16456 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16457 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16458 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016459 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16462 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16463 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16464 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16465 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16466 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16467 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16468 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16469 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16472 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16473 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16474 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16475 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16478 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16479 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16480 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16481 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16482 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16483 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16484 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16485 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016486 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016488 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016490 ACL derivatives :
16491 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16492 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16493 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16494 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16495 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16496 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16497 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16498 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16499
16500req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16501hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16502 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16503 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16504 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16505 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16506 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16507 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16508 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16509 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16510 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16511
16512req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16513hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16514 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16515 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16516 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16517 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16518 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016519 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016520 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16521 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16522
16523req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16524hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16525 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16526 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16527 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16528 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16529 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16530 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16531 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16532
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016533
16534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16536 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16537 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16538 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16539 basic auth is supported.
16540
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016541http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16542 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16543 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16544 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16545 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016546 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16547 basic auth is supported.
16548
16549 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016550 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16551 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16552 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16553 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016555http_auth_pass : string
16556 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16557 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16558 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16559
16560http_auth_type : string
16561 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16562 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16563 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16564
16565http_auth_user : string
16566 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16567 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16568 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016570http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016571 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16572 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16574 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016576method : integer + string
16577 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16578 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16579 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16580 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16581 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16582 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16583 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585 ACL derivatives :
16586 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016588 Example :
16589 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16590 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16591 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593path : string
16594 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16595 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16596 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16597 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16598 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016599 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602 ACL derivatives :
16603 path : exact string match
16604 path_beg : prefix match
16605 path_dir : subdir match
16606 path_dom : domain match
16607 path_end : suffix match
16608 path_len : length match
16609 path_reg : regex match
16610 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016611
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016612query : string
16613 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16614 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16615 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16616 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016617 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016618 which stops before the question mark.
16619
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016620req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16621 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16622 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16623 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16624 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626req.ver : string
16627req_ver : string (deprecated)
16628 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16629 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16630 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016632 ACL derivatives :
16633 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635res.comp : boolean
16636 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16637 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16638 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016640res.comp_algo : string
16641 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16642 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16643 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016645res.cook([<name>]) : string
16646scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16647 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16648 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16649 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016651 ACL derivatives :
16652 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16655scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16656 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16657 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16658 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016660res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16661scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16662 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16663 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16664 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16667 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16668 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16669 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16670 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16671 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16672 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16673 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16674 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16675 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16678 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16679 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16680 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16681 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16682 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016684res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16685shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16686 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16687 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16688 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16689 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16690 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16691 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16692 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16693 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016695 ACL derivatives :
16696 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16697 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16698 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16699 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16700 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16701 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16702 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16703 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16704
16705res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16706shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16707 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16708 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16709 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16710 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16711 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016713res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16714shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16715 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16716 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16717 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16718 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16719 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16720 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016721
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016722res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16723 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16724 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16725 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16726 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16729shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16730 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16731 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16732 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16733 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16734 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16735 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737res.ver : string
16738resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16739 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16740 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016742 ACL derivatives :
16743 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16746 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16747 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016748 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016749 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016751 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16752 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754status : integer
16755 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16756 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16757 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016758
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016759unique-id : string
16760 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16761 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16762 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16763 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16764 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16765 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767url : string
16768 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16769 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16770 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16771 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16772 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16773 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16774 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776 ACL derivatives :
16777 url : exact string match
16778 url_beg : prefix match
16779 url_dir : subdir match
16780 url_dom : domain match
16781 url_end : suffix match
16782 url_len : length match
16783 url_reg : regex match
16784 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786url_ip : ip
16787 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16788 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16789 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16790 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16791 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16792 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16793 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795url_port : integer
16796 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16797 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16798 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16799 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016800
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016801urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16802url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16804 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016805 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16806 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16807 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16808 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016809 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16810 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016811 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16812 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814 ACL derivatives :
16815 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16816 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16817 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16818 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16819 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16820 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16821 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16822 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016823
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825 Example :
16826 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16827 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16828 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16829 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016830
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016831urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16833 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16834 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016835
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016836url32 : integer
16837 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16838 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16839 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16840 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16841 is an unsigned integer.
16842
16843url32+src : binary
16844 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16845 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16846 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16847
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016848
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100168497.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16850---------------------------------------
16851
16852This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16853used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16854purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16855There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16856or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16857any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16858for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16859
16860internal.htx.data : integer
16861 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16862 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16863
16864internal.htx.free : integer
16865 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16866 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16867
16868internal.htx.free_data : integer
16869 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16870 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16871
16872internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16873 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16874 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16875 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16876
16877internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16878 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16879 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16880
16881internal.htx.size : integer
16882 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16883 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16884
16885internal.htx.used : integer
16886 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16887 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16888 direction.
16889
16890internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16891 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16892 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16893 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16894 of the special value :
16895 * head : The oldest inserted block
16896 * tail : The newest inserted block
16897 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16898
16899internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16900 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16901 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16902 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16903 integer or one of the special value :
16904 * head : The oldest inserted block
16905 * tail : The newest inserted block
16906 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16907
16908internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16909 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16910 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16911 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16912 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16913
16914 * head : The oldest inserted block
16915 * tail : The newest inserted block
16916 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16917
16918internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16919 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16920 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16921 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16922 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16923
16924 * head : The oldest inserted block
16925 * tail : The newest inserted block
16926 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16927
16928internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16929 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16930 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16931 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16932 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16933
16934 * head : The oldest inserted block
16935 * tail : The newest inserted block
16936 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16937
16938internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16939 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16940 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16941 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16942 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16943
16944 * head : The oldest inserted block
16945 * tail : The newest inserted block
16946 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16947
16948internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16949 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16950 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16951 it returns false.
16952
16953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169547.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016955---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016957Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16958every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016959order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016961ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16962---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016963FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016964HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016965HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16966HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016967HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16968HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16969HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16970HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16971LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016972METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016973METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016974METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16975METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16976METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16977METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016978METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016979METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016980RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016981REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016982TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016983WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16984---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016985
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169878. Logging
16988----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16991provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16992very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16993provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16994state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016995to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016996headers.
16997
16998In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16999about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17000send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17001
17002 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17003 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17004 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17005 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17006 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017007 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017008 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009
17010The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17011allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17012as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17013while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17014real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17015delay.
17016
17017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170188.1. Log levels
17019---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017020
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017021TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017022source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017023HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17024in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17025track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17026syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17027about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017028
17029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170308.2. Log formats
17031----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017033HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017034and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17035slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17036options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037
17038 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17039 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17040 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17041 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17042 extents.
17043
17044 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17045 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17046 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17047 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17048 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17049
17050 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17051 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17052 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17053 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17054 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17055
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017056 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17057 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17058 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17059 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17060
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017061 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017063Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17064specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17065field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17066servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17067always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17068identifier.
17069
17070Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17071 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17072 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17073 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17074 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17075
17076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170778.2.1. Default log format
17078-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017079
17080This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17081as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17082format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17083
17084 Example :
17085 listen www
17086 mode http
17087 log global
17088 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17089
17090 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17091 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17092 (www/HTTP)
17093
17094 Field Format Extract from the example above
17095 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17096 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17097 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17098 4 'to' to
17099 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17100 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17101
17102Detailed fields description :
17103 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17104 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17105 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17106 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17107 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17108 and processed the connection.
17109 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17110
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017111In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17112"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17113connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17114
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017115It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17116will eventually disappear.
17117
17118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171198.2.2. TCP log format
17120---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017121
17122The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17123is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17124information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17125counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17126emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17127environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17128the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17129sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017130specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17131not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17132fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17133marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017134
17135 Example :
17136 frontend fnt
17137 mode tcp
17138 option tcplog
17139 log global
17140 default_backend bck
17141
17142 backend bck
17143 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17144
17145 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17146 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17147 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17148
17149 Field Format Extract from the example above
17150 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17151 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17152 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17153 4 frontend_name fnt
17154 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17155 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17156 7 bytes_read* 212
17157 8 termination_state --
17158 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17159 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17160
17161Detailed fields description :
17162 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017163 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17164 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17165 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017166 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017167 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017168 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017169
17170 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017171 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17172 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17173 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174
17175 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17176 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17177 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017178 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17179 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17180 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17181 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017182
17183 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17184 and processed the connection.
17185
17186 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17187 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17188 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17189 applications.
17190
17191 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17192 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17193 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17194 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17195 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17196
17197 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17198 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17199 See "Timers" below for more details.
17200
17201 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17202 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17203 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17204 "Timers" below for more details.
17205
17206 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017207 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017208 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17209 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17210 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17211 details.
17212
17213 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17214 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17215 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17216 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17217 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17218
17219 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17220 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17221 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17222 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17223 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17224 for more details.
17225
17226 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017227 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17229 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17230 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017231 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017232
17233 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17234 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17235 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17236 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17237 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17238 caused by a denial of service attack.
17239
17240 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17241 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17242 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17243 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17244 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17245 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17246 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17247 denial of service attack.
17248
17249 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17250 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17251 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17252 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17253 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17254 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17255 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17256 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17257 be processed than on other servers.
17258
17259 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17260 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17261 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17262 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17263 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17264 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17265 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17266 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17267 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17268 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17269 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17270 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17271 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17272
17273 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17274 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17275 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17276 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17277 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17278 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017279 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017280 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17281
17282 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17283 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17284 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17285 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17286 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17287 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017288 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17290 occurs.
17291
17292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172938.2.3. HTTP log format
17294----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
17296The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17297is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17298the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17299are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17300emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17301generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17302"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17303which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017304frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17305is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017306
17307Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17308slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17309with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17310
17311 Example :
17312 frontend http-in
17313 mode http
17314 option httplog
17315 log global
17316 default_backend bck
17317
17318 backend static
17319 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17320
17321 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17322 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17323 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017324 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325
17326 Field Format Extract from the example above
17327 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17328 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017329 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017330 4 frontend_name http-in
17331 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017332 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017333 7 status_code 200
17334 8 bytes_read* 2750
17335 9 captured_request_cookie -
17336 10 captured_response_cookie -
17337 11 termination_state ----
17338 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17339 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17340 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17341 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17342 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344Detailed fields description :
17345 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017346 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17347 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17348 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017349 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017350 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017351 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352
17353 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017354 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17355 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17356 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017357
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017358 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17359 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360
17361 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17362 and processed the connection.
17363
17364 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17365 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17366 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17367
17368 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17369 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17370 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17371 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17372 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17373 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17374
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017375 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17376 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17377 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017378 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017379 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17380 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017381 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17382 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017383
17384 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17385 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017386 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017387
17388 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17389 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017390 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17391 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017392
17393 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17394 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17395 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17396 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17397 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017398 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17399 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017400
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017401 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17402 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17403 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17404 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17405 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17406 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17407 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017408 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409
17410 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17411 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17412 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17413
17414 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17415 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017416 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17418 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17419 overflowing.
17420
17421 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17422 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17423 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17424 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17425 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17426 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17427 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17428 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17429
17430 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17431 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17432 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17433 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17434 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17435 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17436 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17437 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17438
17439 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17440 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17441 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17442 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17443 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17444 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17445 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17446
17447 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017448 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017449 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17450 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17451 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017452 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453 system.
17454
17455 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17456 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17457 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17458 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17459 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17460 caused by a denial of service attack.
17461
17462 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17463 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17464 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17465 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17466 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17467 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17468 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17469 denial of service attack.
17470
17471 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17472 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17473 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17474 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17475 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17476 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17477 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17478 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17479 processed than on other servers.
17480
17481 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17482 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17483 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17484 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17485 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17486 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17487 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17488 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17489 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17490 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17491 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17492 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17493 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17494
17495 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17496 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17497 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17498 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17499 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17500 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017501 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17503
17504 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17505 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17506 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17507 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17508 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17509 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017510 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17512 occurs.
17513
17514 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17515 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17516 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17517 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17518 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17519 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17520 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17521 cookies" below for more details.
17522
17523 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17524 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17525 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17526 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17527 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17528 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17529 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17530 and cookies" below for more details.
17531
17532 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17533 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17534 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17535 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17536 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17537 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17538 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17539 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17540
17541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175428.2.4. Custom log format
17543------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017544
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017545The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017546mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017548HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017549Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17550separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17551prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17552
17553Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17554variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017555("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017556
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017557If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017558as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017559less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17560the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17561
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017562Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017563In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017564in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017565
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017566Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17567'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17568https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17569such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17570
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017571Flags are :
17572 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017573 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017574 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17575 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017576
17577 Example:
17578
17579 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17580 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17581
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017582 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17583
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017584At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17585
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017586 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17587 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017588
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017589the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017590
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017591 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17592 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17593 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017594
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017595and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17596
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017597 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17598 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017599
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017600Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17601
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017602 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017603 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017604 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17605 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17606 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017607 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17608 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17609 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017610 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017611 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17612 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017613 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017614 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17615 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017616 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017617 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017618 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017619 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017620 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017621 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017622 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017623 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17624 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17625 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17626 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17627 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017628 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017629 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17630 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017631 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017632 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17633 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017634 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17635 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17636 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017637 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017638 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17639 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017640 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017641 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17642 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17643 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017644 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017645 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017646 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17647 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17648 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17649 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017650 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017651 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017652 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017653 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017654 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017655 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017656 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17657 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17658 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017659 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017660 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17661 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017662 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017663 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17664 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017665 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017666 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017667 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017668 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017669
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017670 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017671
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017672
176738.2.5. Error log format
17674-----------------------
17675
17676When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17677protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17678By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17679"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017680will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017681logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17682
17683The format looks like this :
17684
17685 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17686 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17687 Connection error during SSL handshake
17688
17689 Field Format Extract from the example above
17690 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17691 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17692 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17693 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17694 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17695
17696These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17697failures.
17698
17699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177008.3. Advanced logging options
17701-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702
17703Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17704just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17705options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17706for more information about their usage.
17707
17708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177098.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17710------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711
17712It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17713haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17714commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17715monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17716ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17717
17718 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17719 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17720 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17721 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17722
17723 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17724 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17725 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017726 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017727 such as other load-balancers.
17728
17729 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17730 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17731 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17732
17733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177348.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17735----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017736
17737The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17738what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17739or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017740"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017741just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17742log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17743after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17744is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17745with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17746with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17747
17748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177498.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17750------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017751
17752Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17753for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17754"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17755retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17756raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17757a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17758file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17759you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17760"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17761
17762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177638.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17764--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017765
17766Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17767multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17768them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17769"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17770logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17771error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17772and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17773too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17774useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17775alternative.
17776
17777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177788.4. Timing events
17779------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017780
17781Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17782reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17783the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17784frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017785mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17786addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17787
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017788Timings events in HTTP mode:
17789
17790 first request 2nd request
17791 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17792 t tr t tr ...
17793 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17794 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17795 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17796 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17797 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17798
17799Timings events in TCP mode:
17800
17801 TCP session
17802 |<----------------->|
17803 t t
17804 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17805 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17806 |<------ Tt ------->|
17807
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017808 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017809 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017810 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17811 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17812 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017813 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017814 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17815 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17816 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17817 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017819 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17820 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17821 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017822 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17823 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17824 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17825 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17826 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17827 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017828
17829 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17830 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17831 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17832 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17833 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17834 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17835 request typed by hand during a test.
17836
17837 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17838 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017839 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017840 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17841 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17842 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17843 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017844
17845 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17846 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17847 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17848 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17849 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17850
17851 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17852 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17853 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17854 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17855 connection never established.
17856
17857 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17858 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17859 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17860 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17861 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17862 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17863 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17864 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17865 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17866 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17867 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17868
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017869 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17870 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17871 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17872 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17873 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17874 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17875
17876 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17877
17878 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17879 "Ta" can never be negative.
17880
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017881 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17882 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017883 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17884 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017885 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017886
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017887 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017888
17889 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017890 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17891 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017892
17893These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17894protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17895that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017896due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17897"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17898that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017899
17900Most common cases :
17901
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017902 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17903 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17904 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17905 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17906 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17907 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17908 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17909 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17910 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17911 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17912 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017913 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017914
17915 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17916 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17917 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17918 of ms on remote networks.
17919
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017920 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17921 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17922 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017923
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017924 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17925 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17926 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17927 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17928 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17929 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17930 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17931 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17932 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017933
17934Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17935
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017936 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017937 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017938 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017939
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017940 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017941 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17942 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017944 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017945 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17946 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17947 flags.
17948
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017949 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17950 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017951 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17952 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17953 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17954 the client connection was maintained open.
17955
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017956 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017957 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017958 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017959 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17960
17961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179628.5. Session state at disconnection
17963-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017964
17965TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17966"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179672-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17968each of which has a special meaning :
17969
17970 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17971 session to terminate :
17972
17973 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17974
17975 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17976 server explicitly refused it.
17977
17978 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17979 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17980 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17981 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017982 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017983
17984 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17985 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017986
17987 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17988 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17989 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17990 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17991 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17992
17993 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17994 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17995 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17996 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17997 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17998
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017999 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18000 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18001
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018002 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18003 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18004 backup connections when going up.
18005
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018006 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18007
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018008 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18009 send or receive data.
18010
18011 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18012 send or receive data.
18013
18014 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18015 with nothing left in the buffers.
18016
18017 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18018
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018019 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18021
18022 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18023 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18024 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18025 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18026 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18027
18028 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18029 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18030
18031 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18032 server (HTTP only).
18033
18034 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18035
18036 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18037 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18038 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18039
18040 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18041 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18042 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18043
18044 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18045
18046 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18047 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18048
18049 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18050 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18051 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18052
18053 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18054 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018055 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18056 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018057
18058 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18059 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18060 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18061 another server.
18062
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018063 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018064 server.
18065
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018066 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18067 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18068 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18069 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18070
18071 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18072 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18073 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18074 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18075
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018076 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18077 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18078 "use-server" rule).
18079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018080 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18081
18082 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18083 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18084
18085 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18086
18087 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18088 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18089 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18090
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018091 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18092 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018093 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018094 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18095 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018097 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18098
18099 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18100 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18101
18102 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18103
18104 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18105
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018106The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18107was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18109starvation, attacks, etc...
18110
18111The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18112alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18113easier finding and understanding.
18114
18115 Flags Reason
18116
18117 -- Normal termination.
18118
18119 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18120 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18121 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18122 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18123
18124 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18125 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18126 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18127 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18128 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18129 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018131 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18132 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018133 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018134
18135 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18136 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18137 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18138
18139 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18140 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18141 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18142 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18143 the server takes too long to respond.
18144
18145 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18146 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18147 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18148 long a time to respond.
18149
18150 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18151 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18152 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18153 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018154 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18155 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018156
18157 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18158 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18159 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18160 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18161 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018162 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018163 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18164 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18165 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18166 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18167 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18168 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18169 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18170 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018171 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018172 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18173 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18174 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018175
18176 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18177 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018178 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18179 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18180 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18181 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018182
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018183 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18184 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018186 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018187 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18188 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018189 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018190 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18191 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18192
18193 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18194 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18195 503 or 504 here.
18196
18197 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18198 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18199 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18200 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18201 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18202
18203 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18204 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018205 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018206 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18207 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18208
18209 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18210 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18211 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18212 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18213 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18214 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18215 between haproxy and the server.
18216
18217 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18218 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18219 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18220 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18221 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18222 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18223 solution is to fix the application.
18224
18225 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18226 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18227 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18228 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18229 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18230 external attacks.
18231
18232 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18233 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018234 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018235 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18236 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18237
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018238 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18239 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18240 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018241 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018242 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018244 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18245 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18246 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18247 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018248 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18249 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18250 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18251 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18252 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018253
18254 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18255 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18256 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18257 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18258
18259 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18260 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18261 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18262 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18263
18264 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18265 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18266 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18267 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18268
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018269The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18270persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18271important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18272re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18273
18274 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18275
18276 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18277 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18278 set on a GET request.
18279
18280 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18281 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018282 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018283 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18284
18285 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18286 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18287 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18288
18289 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18290 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18291 already got a cookie.
18292
18293 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18294 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18295 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18296 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18297 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18298
18299 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18300 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18301 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18302
18303 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18304 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18305 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18306
18307 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18308 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18309
18310 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18311 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18312 then advertised in the response.
18313
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183158.6. Non-printable characters
18316-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018317
18318In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18319consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18320converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18321prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18322being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18323escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18324is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18325'}' when logging headers.
18326
18327Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18328issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18329containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18330
18331Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18332the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18333performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18334
18335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183368.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18337---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018338
18339Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18340achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018341section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018342cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18343the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18344the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018345locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018346not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18347user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18348a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18349wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18350
18351 Examples :
18352 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18353 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18354
18355 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18356 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18357
18358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183598.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18360---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018361
18362Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18363proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18364the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18365server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18366
18367Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18368response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018369section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018370
18371It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018372time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18373appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018374are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18375and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18376follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18377request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18378in the logs.
18379
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018380As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18381frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18382an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18383
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018384 Example :
18385 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18386 listen proxy-out
18387 mode http
18388 option httplog
18389 option logasap
18390 log global
18391 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18392
18393 # log the name of the virtual server
18394 capture request header Host len 20
18395
18396 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18397 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18398
18399 # log the beginning of the referrer
18400 capture request header Referer len 20
18401
18402 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18403 capture response header Server len 20
18404
18405 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18406 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18407
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018408 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018409 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18410
18411 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18412 capture response header Via len 20
18413
18414 # log the URL location during a redirection
18415 capture response header Location len 20
18416
18417 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18418 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18419 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18420 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18421 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18422
18423 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18424 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18425 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18426 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018427 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018428
18429 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18430 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18431 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18432 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18433 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018434 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018435
18436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184378.9. Examples of logs
18438---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018439
18440These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18441them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18442reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18443
18444 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18445 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18446 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18447
18448 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18449 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18450
18451 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18452 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18453 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18454
18455 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18456 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18457
18458 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18459 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18460 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18461
18462 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018463 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018464 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18465 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18466
18467 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18468 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18469 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18470
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018471 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18472 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18473 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18474 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18475 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18476 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018477
18478 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018479 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018480
18481 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18482 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18483 Nothing was sent to any server.
18484
18485 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18486 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18487
18488 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18489 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018490 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018491 send a 408 return code to the client.
18492
18493 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18494 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18495
18496 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18497 5 seconds ("c----").
18498
18499 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18500 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018501 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018502
18503 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018504 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018505 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18506 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18507 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18508 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18509 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018510
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018511
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185129. Supported filters
18513--------------------
18514
18515Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18516accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18517unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18518
18519See also : "filter"
18520
185219.1. Trace
18522----------
18523
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018524filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018525
18526 Arguments:
18527 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18528 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18529
18530 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18531 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18532 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18533 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18534
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018535 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018536 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18537 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18538 amount of the parsed data.
18539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018540 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018541
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018542This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18543callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18544information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18545filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18546
18547Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18548tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18549a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18550
18551
185529.2. HTTP compression
18553---------------------
18554
18555filter compression
18556
18557The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18558keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018559when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18560fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18561done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18562explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18563filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18564listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18565order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018566
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018567See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18568 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018569
18570
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185719.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18572--------------------------------------------
18573
18574filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18575
18576 Arguments :
18577
18578 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18579 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18580 parsed.
18581
18582 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18583 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18584 part must be placed in its own scope.
18585
18586The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18587external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018588streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018589exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18590also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18591
18592SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18593the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18594
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018595For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018596"doc/SPOE.txt".
18597
18598Important note:
18599 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18600 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18601
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186029.4. Cache
18603----------
18604
18605filter cache <name>
18606
18607 Arguments :
18608
18609 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18610
18611The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18612"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018613cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018614other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18615case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18616is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18617filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018618listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18619order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018620
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018621See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18622 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18623
18624
186259.5. Fcgi-app
18626-------------
18627
18628filter fcg-app <name>
18629
18630 Arguments :
18631
18632 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18633
18634The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18635request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18636reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18637used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18638implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18639used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18640fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18641used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18642order.
18643
18644See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18645 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18646
18647
1864810. FastCGI applications
18649-------------------------
18650
18651HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18652feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18653the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18654FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18655servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18656FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18657backend.
18658
18659HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18660application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18661connection.
18662
1866310.1. Setup
18664-----------
18665
1866610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18667--------------------------
18668
18669fcgi-app <name>
18670 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18671 document root must be defined.
18672
18673acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18674 Declare or complete an access list.
18675
18676 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18677 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18678 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18679 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18680 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18681
18682docroot <path>
18683 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18684 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18685 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18686
18687index <script-name>
18688 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18689 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18690 is an optional setting.
18691
18692 Example :
18693 index index.php
18694
18695log-stderr global
18696log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18697 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18698 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18699
18700 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18701 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18702
18703pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18704 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18705 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18706 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18707
18708 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18709 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18710 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18711 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18712
18713 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18714 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18715
18716path-info <regex>
18717 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18718 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18719 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18720 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18721 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18722
18723 Example :
18724 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18725
18726option get-values
18727no option get-values
18728 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18729
18730 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18731 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18732
18733 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18734 application will accept.
18735
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018736 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18737 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018738
18739 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18740 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18741 option is disabled.
18742
18743 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18744 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18745 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18746 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18747 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18748 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18749
18750option keep-conn
18751no option keep-conn
18752 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18753 sending a response.
18754
18755 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18756 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18757
18758option max-reqs <reqs>
18759 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18760 accept.
18761
18762 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18763 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18764 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18765 to 1.
18766
18767option mpxs-conns
18768no option mpxs-conns
18769 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18770
18771 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18772 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18773
18774set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18775 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18776 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18777 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18778 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18779
18780 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18781 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18782 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18783
18784 Example :
18785 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18786 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18787
18788 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18789
18790
1879110.1.2. Proxy section
18792---------------------
18793
18794use-fcgi-app <name>
18795 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18796
18797 Arguments :
18798 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18799
18800 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18801 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18802 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18803 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18804 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18805
18806 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18807 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18808 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18809 application are evaluated.
18810
18811
1881210.1.3. Example
18813---------------
18814
18815 frontend front-http
18816 mode http
18817 bind *:80
18818 bind *:
18819
18820 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18821 default_backend back-static
18822
18823 backend back-static
18824 mode http
18825 server www A.B.C.D:80
18826
18827 backend back-dynamic
18828 mode http
18829 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18830 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18831
18832 fcgi-app php-fpm
18833 log-stderr global
18834 option keep-conn
18835
18836 docroot /var/www/my-app
18837 index index.php
18838 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18839
18840
1884110.2. Default parameters
18842------------------------
18843
18844A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18845the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18846scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18847applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18848
18849 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18850 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18851 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18852 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18853 | | |
18854 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18855 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18856 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18857 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18858 | | application. |
18859 | | |
18860 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18861 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18862 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18863 | | |
18864 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18865 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18866 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18867 | | the application's configuration. |
18868 | | |
18869 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18870 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18871 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18872 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18873 | | |
18874 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18875 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18876 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18877 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18878 | | be defined. |
18879 | | |
18880 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18881 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18882 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18883 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18884 | | is not set too. |
18885 | | |
18886 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18887 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18888 | | set. |
18889 | | |
18890 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18891 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18892 | | the request. |
18893 | | |
18894 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18895 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18896 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18897 | | |
18898 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18899 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18900 | | script to process the request. |
18901 | | |
18902 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18903 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18904 | | |
18905 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18906 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18907 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18908 | | |
18909 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18910 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18911 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18912 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18913 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18914 | | |
18915 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18916 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18917 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18918 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18919 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18920 | | side. |
18921 | | |
18922 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18923 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18924 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18925 | | connected to. |
18926 | | |
18927 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18928 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18929 | | |
18930 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18931 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18932 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18933 | | |
18934 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18935
18936
1893710.3. Limitations
18938------------------
18939
18940The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18941way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18942during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18943establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18944application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18945or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18946message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18947these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18948and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18949
18950Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18951request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18952requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18953
18954About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18955into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18956fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18957"http-request" ones.
18958
18959Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18960FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18961processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18962must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18963here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018965/*
18966 * Local variables:
18967 * fill-column: 79
18968 * End:
18969 */